Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/gtkutil.c @ 109663:a4c55c0d8da2
* src/sysdep.c: Move include term.h last of includes (Bug#6812).
author | Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se> |
---|---|
date | Fri, 06 Aug 2010 19:38:01 +0200 |
parents | c4c8e4a16194 |
children | d9a022ec322c |
rev | line source |
---|---|
49323 | 1 /* Functions for creating and updating GTK widgets. |
106815 | 2 Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 |
79759 | 3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
49323 | 4 |
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
6 | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify |
49323 | 8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or |
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
10 (at your option) any later version. |
49323 | 11 |
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
15 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
16 | |
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
49323 | 19 |
80608
83a48972e1ea
Include <config.h> instead of "config.h".
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
79759
diff
changeset
|
20 #include <config.h> |
49323 | 21 |
22 #ifdef USE_GTK | |
49359
14cf50ecf91a
gtkutil.c: Must include stdio.h before termhooks.h
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49325
diff
changeset
|
23 #include <string.h> |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
24 #include <signal.h> |
49359
14cf50ecf91a
gtkutil.c: Must include stdio.h before termhooks.h
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49325
diff
changeset
|
25 #include <stdio.h> |
105669
68dd71358159
* alloc.c: Do not define struct catchtag.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105522
diff
changeset
|
26 #include <setjmp.h> |
49323 | 27 #include "lisp.h" |
28 #include "xterm.h" | |
29 #include "blockinput.h" | |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
30 #include "syssignal.h" |
49323 | 31 #include "window.h" |
32 #include "gtkutil.h" | |
33 #include "termhooks.h" | |
51408
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
34 #include "keyboard.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
35 #include "charset.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
36 #include "coding.h" |
49323 | 37 #include <gdk/gdkkeysyms.h> |
108082
38a6893c8b9e
* gtkutil.c: Include xsettings.h for Ftool_bar_get_system_style.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
108024
diff
changeset
|
38 #include "xsettings.h" |
49323 | 39 |
97059
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
40 #ifdef HAVE_XFT |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
41 #include <X11/Xft/Xft.h> |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
42 #endif |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
43 |
49323 | 44 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT(f) \ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
45 (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f)) |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
46 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
47 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH(f) \ |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
48 (FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
49 |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
50 /* Avoid "differ in sign" warnings */ |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
51 #define SSDATA(x) ((char *) SDATA (x)) |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
52 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
53 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_SET_HAS_WINDOW |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
54 #define gtk_widget_set_has_window(w, b) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
55 (gtk_fixed_set_has_window (GTK_FIXED (w), b)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
56 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
57 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_DIALOG_GET_ACTION_AREA |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
58 #define gtk_dialog_get_action_area(w) ((w)->action_area) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
59 #define gtk_dialog_get_content_area(w) ((w)->vbox) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
60 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
61 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_GET_SENSITIVE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
62 #define gtk_widget_get_sensitive(w) (GTK_WIDGET_SENSITIVE (w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
63 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
64 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_ADJUSTMENT_GET_PAGE_SIZE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
65 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_size(w, s) ((w)->page_size = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
66 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment(w, s) ((w)->page_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
67 #define gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment(w) ((w)->step_increment) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
68 #define gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment(w, s) ((w)->step_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
69 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
70 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION > 2 || GTK_MINOR_VERSION > 11 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
71 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_set_submenu ((w), NULL) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
72 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
73 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_remove_submenu ((w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
74 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
75 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
76 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
77 /*********************************************************************** |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
78 Display handling functions |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
79 ***********************************************************************/ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
80 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
81 /* Keep track of the default display, or NULL if there is none. Emacs |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
82 may close all its displays. */ |
84621 | 83 |
84 static GdkDisplay *gdpy_def; | |
85 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
86 /* When the GTK widget W is to be created on a display for F that |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
87 is not the default display, set the display for W. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
88 W can be a GtkMenu or a GtkWindow widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
89 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
90 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
91 xg_set_screen (GtkWidget *w, FRAME_PTR f) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
92 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
93 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f) != GDK_DISPLAY ()) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
94 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
95 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
96 GdkScreen *gscreen = gdk_display_get_default_screen (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
97 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
98 if (GTK_IS_MENU (w)) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
99 gtk_menu_set_screen (GTK_MENU (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
100 else |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
101 gtk_window_set_screen (GTK_WINDOW (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
102 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
103 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
104 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
105 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
106 /* Open a display named by DISPLAY_NAME. The display is returned in *DPY. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
107 *DPY is set to NULL if the display can't be opened. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
108 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
109 Returns non-zero if display could be opened, zero if display could not |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
110 be opened, and less than zero if the GTK version doesn't support |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
111 multipe displays. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
112 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
113 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
114 xg_display_open (char *display_name, Display **dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
115 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
116 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
117 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
118 gdpy = gdk_display_open (display_name); |
102705
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
119 if (!gdpy_def && gdpy) |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
120 { |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
121 gdpy_def = gdpy; |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
122 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
123 gdpy); |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
124 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
125 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
126 *dpy = gdpy ? GDK_DISPLAY_XDISPLAY (gdpy) : NULL; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
127 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
128 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
129 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
130 /* Close display DPY. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
131 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
132 void |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
133 xg_display_close (Display *dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
134 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
135 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
136 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
137 /* If this is the default display, try to change it before closing. |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
138 If there is no other display to use, gdpy_def is set to NULL, and |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
139 the next call to xg_display_open resets the default display. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
140 if (gdk_display_get_default () == gdpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
141 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
142 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo; |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
143 GdkDisplay *gdpy_new = NULL; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
144 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
145 /* Find another display. */ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
146 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
147 if (dpyinfo->display != dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
148 { |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
149 gdpy_new = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpyinfo->display); |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
150 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
151 gdpy_new); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
152 break; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
153 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
154 gdpy_def = gdpy_new; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
155 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
156 |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
157 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION == 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION < 10 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
158 /* GTK 2.2-2.8 has a bug that makes gdk_display_close crash (bug |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
159 http://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). This way we |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
160 can continue running, but there will be memory leaks. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
161 g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (gdpy)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
162 #else |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
163 /* This seems to be fixed in GTK 2.10. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
164 gdk_display_close (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
165 #endif |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
166 } |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
167 |
49323 | 168 |
169 /*********************************************************************** | |
170 Utility functions | |
171 ***********************************************************************/ | |
172 /* The next two variables and functions are taken from lwlib. */ | |
173 static widget_value *widget_value_free_list; | |
174 static int malloc_cpt; | |
175 | |
176 /* Allocate a widget_value structure, either by taking one from the | |
177 widget_value_free_list or by malloc:ing a new one. | |
178 | |
179 Return a pointer to the allocated structure. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
180 |
49323 | 181 widget_value * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
182 malloc_widget_value (void) |
49323 | 183 { |
184 widget_value *wv; | |
185 if (widget_value_free_list) | |
186 { | |
187 wv = widget_value_free_list; | |
188 widget_value_free_list = wv->free_list; | |
189 wv->free_list = 0; | |
190 } | |
191 else | |
192 { | |
69025
5d9232b72d14
(malloc_widget_value): Use xmalloc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
68922
diff
changeset
|
193 wv = (widget_value *) xmalloc (sizeof (widget_value)); |
49323 | 194 malloc_cpt++; |
195 } | |
196 memset (wv, 0, sizeof (widget_value)); | |
197 return wv; | |
198 } | |
199 | |
200 /* This is analogous to free. It frees only what was allocated | |
201 by malloc_widget_value, and no substructures. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
202 |
49323 | 203 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
204 free_widget_value (widget_value *wv) |
49323 | 205 { |
206 if (wv->free_list) | |
207 abort (); | |
208 | |
209 if (malloc_cpt > 25) | |
210 { | |
211 /* When the number of already allocated cells is too big, | |
212 We free it. */ | |
100633
5395c014feb8
* buffer.c (init_buffer): Use realloc instead of xrealloc.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
100501
diff
changeset
|
213 xfree (wv); |
49323 | 214 malloc_cpt--; |
215 } | |
216 else | |
217 { | |
218 wv->free_list = widget_value_free_list; | |
219 widget_value_free_list = wv; | |
220 } | |
221 } | |
222 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
223 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
224 /* Create and return the cursor to be used for popup menus and |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
225 scroll bars on display DPY. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
226 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
227 GdkCursor * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
228 xg_create_default_cursor (Display *dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
229 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
230 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
231 return gdk_cursor_new_for_display (gdpy, GDK_LEFT_PTR); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
232 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
233 |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
234 /* Apply GMASK to GPIX and return a GdkPixbuf with an alpha channel. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
235 |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
236 static GdkPixbuf * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
237 xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (GdkPixmap *gpix, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
238 GdkPixmap *gmask, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
239 GdkColormap *cmap) |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
240 { |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
241 int width, height; |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
242 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf, *tmp_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
243 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
244 gdk_drawable_get_size (gpix, &width, &height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
245 tmp_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, gpix, cmap, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
246 0, 0, 0, 0, width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
247 icon_buf = gdk_pixbuf_add_alpha (tmp_buf, FALSE, 0, 0, 0); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
248 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (tmp_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
249 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
250 if (gmask) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
251 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
252 GdkPixbuf *mask_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
253 gmask, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
254 NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
255 0, 0, 0, 0, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
256 width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
257 guchar *pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
258 guchar *mask_pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
259 int rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
260 int mask_rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
261 int y; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
262 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
263 for (y = 0; y < height; ++y) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
264 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
265 guchar *iconptr, *maskptr; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
266 int x; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
267 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
268 iconptr = pixels + y * rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
269 maskptr = mask_pixels + y * mask_rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
270 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
271 for (x = 0; x < width; ++x) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
272 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
273 /* In a bitmap, RGB is either 255/255/255 or 0/0/0. Checking |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
274 just R is sufficient. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
275 if (maskptr[0] == 0) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
276 iconptr[3] = 0; /* 0, 1, 2 is R, G, B. 3 is alpha. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
277 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
278 iconptr += rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
279 maskptr += mask_rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
280 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
281 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
282 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
283 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (mask_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
284 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
285 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
286 return icon_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
287 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
288 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
289 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
290 file_for_image (Lisp_Object image) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
291 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
292 Lisp_Object specified_file = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
293 Lisp_Object tail; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
294 extern Lisp_Object QCfile; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
295 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
296 for (tail = XCDR (image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
297 NILP (specified_file) && CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
298 tail = XCDR (XCDR (tail))) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
299 if (EQ (XCAR (tail), QCfile)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
300 specified_file = XCAR (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
301 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
302 return specified_file; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
303 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
304 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
305 /* For the image defined in IMG, make and return a GtkImage. For displays with |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
306 8 planes or less we must make a GdkPixbuf and apply the mask manually. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
307 Otherwise the highlightning and dimming the tool bar code in GTK does |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
308 will look bad. For display with more than 8 planes we just use the |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
309 pixmap and mask directly. For monochrome displays, GTK doesn't seem |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
310 able to use external pixmaps, it looks bad whatever we do. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
311 The image is defined on the display where frame F is. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
312 WIDGET is used to find the GdkColormap to use for the GdkPixbuf. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
313 If OLD_WIDGET is NULL, a new widget is constructed and returned. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
314 If OLD_WIDGET is not NULL, that widget is modified. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
315 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
316 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
317 xg_get_image_for_pixmap (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
318 struct image *img, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
319 GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
320 GtkImage *old_widget) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
321 { |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
322 GdkPixmap *gpix; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
323 GdkPixmap *gmask; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
324 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
325 GdkColormap *cmap; |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
326 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
327 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
328 /* If we have a file, let GTK do all the image handling. |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
329 This seems to be the only way to make insensitive and activated icons |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
330 look good in all cases. */ |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
331 Lisp_Object specified_file = file_for_image (img->spec); |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
332 Lisp_Object file; |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
333 |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
334 /* We already loaded the image once before calling this |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
335 function, so this only fails if the image file has been removed. |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
336 In that case, use the pixmap already loaded. */ |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
337 |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
338 if (STRINGP (specified_file) |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
339 && STRINGP (file = x_find_image_file (specified_file))) |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
340 { |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
341 if (! old_widget) |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
342 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_file (SSDATA (file))); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
343 else |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
344 gtk_image_set_from_file (old_widget, SSDATA (file)); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
345 |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
346 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
347 } |
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
348 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
349 /* No file, do the image handling ourselves. This will look very bad |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
350 on a monochrome display, and sometimes bad on all displays with |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
351 certain themes. */ |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
352 |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
353 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
354 gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->pixmap); |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
355 gmask = img->mask ? gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->mask) : 0; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
356 |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
357 /* This is a workaround to make icons look good on pseudo color |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
358 displays. Apparently GTK expects the images to have an alpha |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
359 channel. If they don't, insensitive and activated icons will |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
360 look bad. This workaround does not work on monochrome displays, |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
361 and is strictly not needed on true color/static color displays (i.e. |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
362 16 bits and higher). But we do it anyway so we get a pixbuf that is |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
363 not associated with the img->pixmap. The img->pixmap may be removed |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
364 by clearing the image cache and then the tool bar redraw fails, since |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
365 Gtk+ assumes the pixmap is always there. */ |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
366 cmap = gtk_widget_get_colormap (widget); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
367 icon_buf = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, cmap); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
368 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
369 if (! old_widget) |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
370 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
371 else |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
372 gtk_image_set_from_pixbuf (old_widget, icon_buf); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
373 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
374 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
375 |
56268
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
376 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gpix)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
377 if (gmask) g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gmask)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
378 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
379 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
380 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
381 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
382 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
383 /* Set CURSOR on W and all widgets W contain. We must do like this |
49323 | 384 for scroll bars and menu because they create widgets internally, |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
385 and it is those widgets that are visible. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
386 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
387 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
388 xg_set_cursor (GtkWidget *w, GdkCursor *cursor) |
49323 | 389 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
390 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window(w); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
391 GList *children = gdk_window_peek_children (window); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
392 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
393 gdk_window_set_cursor (window, cursor); |
49323 | 394 |
395 /* The scroll bar widget has more than one GDK window (had to look at | |
396 the source to figure this out), and there is no way to set cursor | |
397 on widgets in GTK. So we must set the cursor for all GDK windows. | |
398 Ditto for menus. */ | |
399 | |
400 for ( ; children; children = g_list_next (children)) | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
401 gdk_window_set_cursor (GDK_WINDOW (children->data), cursor); |
49323 | 402 } |
403 | |
404 /* Insert NODE into linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
405 |
49323 | 406 static void |
407 xg_list_insert (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
408 { | |
409 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
410 |
49323 | 411 if (list_start) list_start->prev = node; |
412 node->next = list_start; | |
413 node->prev = 0; | |
414 list->next = node; | |
415 } | |
416 | |
417 /* Remove NODE from linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
418 |
49323 | 419 static void |
420 xg_list_remove (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
421 { | |
422 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
423 if (node == list_start) | |
424 { | |
425 list->next = node->next; | |
426 if (list->next) list->next->prev = 0; | |
427 } | |
428 else | |
429 { | |
430 node->prev->next = node->next; | |
431 if (node->next) node->next->prev = node->prev; | |
432 } | |
433 } | |
434 | |
435 /* Allocate and return a utf8 version of STR. If STR is already | |
436 utf8 or NULL, just return STR. | |
437 If not, a new string is allocated and the caller must free the result | |
438 with g_free. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
439 |
49323 | 440 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
441 get_utf8_string (char *str) |
49323 | 442 { |
443 char *utf8_str = str; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
444 |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
445 if (!str) return NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
446 |
49323 | 447 /* If not UTF-8, try current locale. */ |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
448 if (!g_utf8_validate (str, -1, NULL)) |
49323 | 449 utf8_str = g_locale_to_utf8 (str, -1, 0, 0, 0); |
450 | |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
451 if (!utf8_str) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
452 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
453 /* Probably some control characters in str. Escape them. */ |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
454 size_t nr_bad = 0; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
455 gsize bytes_read; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
456 gsize bytes_written; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
457 unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *)str; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
458 char *cp, *up; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
459 GError *error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
460 |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
461 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
462 &bytes_written, &error)) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
463 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
464 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
465 ++nr_bad; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
466 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
467 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
468 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
469 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
470 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
471 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
472 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
473 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
474 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
475 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
476 if (cp) g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
477 |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
478 up = utf8_str = xmalloc (strlen (str) + nr_bad * 4 + 1); |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
479 p = (unsigned char *)str; |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
480 |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
481 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
482 &bytes_written, &error)) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
483 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
484 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
485 strncpy (up, (char *)p, bytes_written); |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
486 sprintf (up + bytes_written, "\\%03o", p[bytes_written]); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
487 up[bytes_written+4] = '\0'; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
488 up += bytes_written+4; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
489 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
490 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
491 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
492 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
493 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
494 if (cp) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
495 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
496 strcat (utf8_str, cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
497 g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
498 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
499 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
500 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
501 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
502 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
503 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
504 } |
49323 | 505 return utf8_str; |
506 } | |
507 | |
508 | |
509 | |
510 /*********************************************************************** | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
511 Tooltips |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
512 ***********************************************************************/ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
513 /* Gtk+ calls this callback when the parent of our tooltip dummy changes. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
514 We use that to pop down the tooltip. This happens if Gtk+ for some |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
515 reason wants to change or hide the tooltip. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
516 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
517 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
518 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
519 static void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
520 hierarchy_ch_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
521 GtkWidget *previous_toplevel, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
522 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
523 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
524 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
525 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
526 GtkWidget *top = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
527 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
528 if (! top || ! GTK_IS_WINDOW (top)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
529 gtk_widget_hide (previous_toplevel); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
530 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
531 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
532 /* Callback called when Gtk+ thinks a tooltip should be displayed. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
533 We use it to get the tooltip window and the tooltip widget so |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
534 we can manipulate the ourselves. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
535 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
536 Return FALSE ensures that the tooltip is not shown. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
537 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
538 static gboolean |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
539 qttip_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
540 gint xpos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
541 gint ypos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
542 gboolean keyboard_mode, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
543 GtkTooltip *tooltip, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
544 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
545 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
546 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
547 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
548 if (x->ttip_widget == NULL) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
549 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
550 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
551 x->ttip_widget = tooltip; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
552 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (tooltip)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
553 x->ttip_lbl = gtk_label_new (""); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
554 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_lbl)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
555 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (tooltip, x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
556 x->ttip_window = GTK_WINDOW (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
557 /* Realize so we can safely get screen later on. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
558 gtk_widget_realize (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
559 gtk_widget_realize (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
560 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
561 g_signal_connect (x->ttip_lbl, "hierarchy-changed", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
562 G_CALLBACK (hierarchy_ch_cb), f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
563 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
564 return FALSE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
565 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
566 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
567 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
568 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
569 /* Prepare a tooltip to be shown, i.e. calculate WIDTH and HEIGHT. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
570 Return zero if no system tooltip available, non-zero otherwise. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
571 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
572 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
573 xg_prepare_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
574 Lisp_Object string, |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
575 int *width, |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
576 int *height) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
577 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
578 #ifndef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
579 return 0; |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
580 #else |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
581 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
582 GtkWidget *widget; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
583 GdkWindow *gwin; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
584 GdkScreen *screen; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
585 GtkSettings *settings; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
586 gboolean tt_enabled = TRUE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
587 GtkRequisition req; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
588 Lisp_Object encoded_string; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
589 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
590 if (!x->ttip_lbl) return 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
591 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
592 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
593 encoded_string = ENCODE_UTF_8 (string); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
594 widget = GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
595 gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
596 screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
597 settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
598 g_object_get (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", &tt_enabled, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
599 if (tt_enabled) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
600 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
601 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
602 /* Record that we disabled it so it can be enabled again. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
603 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_window), "restore-tt", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
604 (gpointer)f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
605 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
606 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
607 /* Prevent Gtk+ from hiding tooltip on mouse move and such. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
608 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
609 (gtk_widget_get_display (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window))), |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
610 "gdk-display-current-tooltip", NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
611 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
612 /* Put out dummy widget in so we can get callbacks for unrealize and |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
613 hierarchy-changed. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
614 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (x->ttip_widget, widget); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
615 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
616 gtk_tooltip_set_text (x->ttip_widget, SDATA (encoded_string)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
617 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window), &req); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
618 if (width) *width = req.width; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
619 if (height) *height = req.height; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
620 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
621 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
622 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
623 return 1; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
624 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
625 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
626 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
627 /* Show the tooltip at ROOT_X and ROOT_Y. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
628 xg_prepare_tooltip must have been called before this function. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
629 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
630 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
631 xg_show_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, int root_x, int root_y) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
632 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
633 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
634 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
635 if (x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
636 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
637 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
638 gtk_window_move (x->ttip_window, root_x, root_y); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
639 gtk_widget_show_all (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
640 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
641 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
642 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
643 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
644 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
645 /* Hide tooltip if shown. Do nothing if not shown. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
646 Return non-zero if tip was hidden, non-ero if not (i.e. not using |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
647 system tooltips). */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
648 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
649 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
650 xg_hide_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
651 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
652 int ret = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
653 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
654 if (f->output_data.x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
655 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
656 GtkWindow *win = f->output_data.x->ttip_window; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
657 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
658 gtk_widget_hide (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
659 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
660 if (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (win), "restore-tt")) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
661 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
662 GdkWindow *gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
663 GdkScreen *screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
664 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
665 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", TRUE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
666 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
667 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
668 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
669 ret = 1; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
670 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
671 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
672 return ret; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
673 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
674 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
675 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
676 /*********************************************************************** |
49323 | 677 General functions for creating widgets, resizing, events, e.t.c. |
678 ***********************************************************************/ | |
679 | |
680 /* Make a geometry string and pass that to GTK. It seems this is the | |
681 only way to get geometry position right if the user explicitly | |
682 asked for a position when starting Emacs. | |
683 F is the frame we shall set geometry for. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
684 |
49323 | 685 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
686 xg_set_geometry (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 687 { |
107851
2a74858bccc0
Fix so top -10 and left -10 in frame parameters work.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
688 if (f->size_hint_flags & (USPosition | PPosition)) |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
689 { |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
690 int left = f->left_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
691 int xneg = f->size_hint_flags & XNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
692 int top = f->top_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
693 int yneg = f->size_hint_flags & YNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
694 char geom_str[32]; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
695 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
696 if (xneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
697 left = -left; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
698 if (yneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
699 top = -top; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
700 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
701 sprintf (geom_str, "=%dx%d%c%d%c%d", |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
702 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
107891
bf5fce1e8e34
Set USER_POS in hint_flags to work around Cygwin problem.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107851
diff
changeset
|
703 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
704 (xneg ? '-' : '+'), left, |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
705 (yneg ? '-' : '+'), top); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
706 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
707 if (!gtk_window_parse_geometry (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
708 geom_str)) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
709 fprintf (stderr, "Failed to parse: '%s'\n", geom_str); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
710 } |
49323 | 711 } |
712 | |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
713 /* Clear under internal border if any. As we use a mix of Gtk+ and X calls |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
714 and use a GtkFixed widget, this doesn't happen automatically. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
715 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
716 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
717 xg_clear_under_internal_border (FRAME_PTR f) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
718 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
719 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0) |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
720 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
721 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
722 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
723 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
724 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
725 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
726 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
727 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
728 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
729 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
730 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
731 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
732 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
733 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
734 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
735 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
736 0, FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
737 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
738 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
739 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
740 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
741 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
742 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
743 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
744 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
745 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
746 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
747 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
748 /* Function to handle resize of our frame. As we have a Gtk+ tool bar |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
749 and a Gtk+ menu bar, we get resize events for the edit part of the |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
750 frame only. We let Gtk+ deal with the Gtk+ parts. |
49323 | 751 F is the frame to resize. |
752 PIXELWIDTH, PIXELHEIGHT is the new size in pixels. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
753 |
49323 | 754 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
755 xg_frame_resized (FRAME_PTR f, int pixelwidth, int pixelheight) |
49323 | 756 { |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
757 int rows, columns; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
758 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
759 if (pixelwidth == -1 && pixelheight == -1) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
760 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
761 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
762 gdk_window_get_geometry (gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)), |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
763 0, 0, |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
764 &pixelwidth, &pixelheight, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
765 else return; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
766 } |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
767 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
768 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
769 rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelheight); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
770 columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, pixelwidth); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
771 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
772 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
773 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
774 || pixelwidth != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
775 || pixelheight != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) |
49323 | 776 { |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
777 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
778 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
779 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
780 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
100498
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
781 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
782 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
783 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
49323 | 784 } |
785 } | |
786 | |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
787 /* Resize the outer window of frame F after chainging the height. |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
788 COLUMNS/ROWS is the size the edit area shall have after the resize. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
789 |
49323 | 790 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
791 xg_frame_set_char_size (FRAME_PTR f, int cols, int rows) |
49323 | 792 { |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
793 int pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows) |
49323 | 794 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
795 int pixelwidth; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
796 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
797 if (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) == 0) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
798 return; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
799 |
49323 | 800 /* Take into account the size of the scroll bar. Always use the |
801 number of columns occupied by the scroll bar here otherwise we | |
802 might end up with a frame width that is not a multiple of the | |
803 frame's character width which is bad for vertically split | |
804 windows. */ | |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
805 f->scroll_bar_actual_width |
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
806 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
49323 | 807 |
50099
a62497b91c74
Use generic compute_fringe_widths.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50063
diff
changeset
|
808 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0); |
49323 | 809 |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
810 /* FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH uses scroll_bar_actual_width, so call it |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
811 after calculating that value. */ |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
812 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
813 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
814 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
815 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
816 /* Do this before resize, as we don't know yet if we will be resized. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
817 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
818 |
49323 | 819 /* Must resize our top level widget. Font size may have changed, |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
820 but not rows/cols. */ |
49323 | 821 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
822 pixelwidth, pixelheight); | |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
823 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
103198
f63bce93c7a1
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Set frame pixel width/height to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103022
diff
changeset
|
824 |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
825 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
826 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
827 |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
828 /* We can not call change_frame_size for a mapped frame, |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
829 we can not set pixel width/height either. The window manager may |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
830 override our resize request, XMonad does this all the time. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
831 The best we can do is try to sync, so lisp code sees the updated |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
832 size as fast as possible. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
833 For unmapped windows, we can set rows/cols. When |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
834 the frame is mapped again we will (hopefully) get the correct size. */ |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
835 if (f->async_visible) |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
836 { |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
837 /* Must call this to flush out events */ |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
838 (void)gtk_events_pending (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
839 gdk_flush (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
840 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
841 } |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
842 else |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
843 { |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
844 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
845 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
846 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
847 } |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
848 } |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
849 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
850 /* Handle height/width changes (i.e. add/remove/move menu/toolbar). |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
851 The policy is to keep the number of editable lines. */ |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
852 |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
853 static void |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
854 xg_height_or_width_changed (FRAME_PTR f) |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
855 { |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
856 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
857 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
858 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
859 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = 0; |
53275
a07a0bae1990
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Call x_wm_set_size_hint.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53069
diff
changeset
|
860 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
49323 | 861 } |
862 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
863 /* Convert an X Window WSESC on display DPY to its corresponding GtkWidget. |
49323 | 864 Must be done like this, because GtkWidget:s can have "hidden" |
865 X Window that aren't accessible. | |
866 | |
867 Return 0 if no widget match WDESC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
868 |
49323 | 869 GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
870 xg_win_to_widget (Display *dpy, Window wdesc) |
49323 | 871 { |
872 gpointer gdkwin; | |
873 GtkWidget *gwdesc = 0; | |
874 | |
875 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
876 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
877 gdkwin = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy), |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
878 wdesc); |
49323 | 879 if (gdkwin) |
880 { | |
881 GdkEvent event; | |
882 event.any.window = gdkwin; | |
883 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&event); | |
884 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
885 |
49323 | 886 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
887 return gwdesc; | |
888 } | |
889 | |
890 /* Fill in the GdkColor C so that it represents PIXEL. | |
891 W is the widget that color will be used for. Used to find colormap. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
892 |
49323 | 893 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
894 xg_pix_to_gcolor (GtkWidget *w, long unsigned int pixel, GdkColor *c) |
49323 | 895 { |
896 GdkColormap *map = gtk_widget_get_colormap (w); | |
897 gdk_colormap_query_color (map, pixel, c); | |
898 } | |
899 | |
900 /* Create and set up the GTK widgets for frame F. | |
901 Return 0 if creation failed, non-zero otherwise. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
902 |
49323 | 903 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
904 xg_create_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 905 { |
906 GtkWidget *wtop; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
907 GtkWidget *wvbox, *whbox; |
49323 | 908 GtkWidget *wfixed; |
909 GdkColor bg; | |
910 GtkRcStyle *style; | |
911 char *title = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
912 |
49323 | 913 BLOCK_INPUT; |
914 | |
91632
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
915 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)) |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
916 wtop = gtk_plug_new (f->output_data.x->parent_desc); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
917 else |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
918 wtop = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
919 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
920 xg_set_screen (wtop, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
921 |
49323 | 922 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
923 whbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
49323 | 924 wfixed = gtk_fixed_new (); /* Must have this to place scroll bars */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
925 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
926 if (! wtop || ! wvbox || ! whbox || ! wfixed) |
49323 | 927 { |
928 if (wtop) gtk_widget_destroy (wtop); | |
929 if (wvbox) gtk_widget_destroy (wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
930 if (whbox) gtk_widget_destroy (whbox); |
49323 | 931 if (wfixed) gtk_widget_destroy (wfixed); |
932 | |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
933 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
49323 | 934 return 0; |
935 } | |
936 | |
937 /* Use same names as the Xt port does. I.e. Emacs.pane.emacs by default */ | |
938 gtk_widget_set_name (wtop, EMACS_CLASS); | |
939 gtk_widget_set_name (wvbox, "pane"); | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
940 gtk_widget_set_name (wfixed, SSDATA (Vx_resource_name)); |
49323 | 941 |
942 /* If this frame has a title or name, set it in the title bar. */ | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
943 if (! NILP (f->title)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->title)); |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
944 else if (! NILP (f->name)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->name)); |
49323 | 945 |
946 if (title) gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), title); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
947 |
49323 | 948 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = wtop; |
949 FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) = wfixed; | |
950 f->output_data.x->vbox_widget = wvbox; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
951 f->output_data.x->hbox_widget = whbox; |
49323 | 952 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
953 gtk_widget_set_has_window (wfixed, TRUE); |
49323 | 954 |
955 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wtop), wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
956 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
957 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (whbox), wfixed, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 958 |
959 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f)) | |
960 update_frame_tool_bar (f); | |
961 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
962 /* We don't want this widget double buffered, because we draw on it |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
963 with regular X drawing primitives, so from a GTK/GDK point of |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
964 view, the widget is totally blank. When an expose comes, this |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
965 will make the widget blank, and then Emacs redraws it. This flickers |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
966 a lot, so we turn off double buffering. */ |
49323 | 967 gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (wfixed, FALSE); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
968 |
49323 | 969 gtk_window_set_wmclass (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
970 SSDATA (Vx_resource_name), |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
971 SSDATA (Vx_resource_class)); |
49323 | 972 |
973 /* Add callback to do nothing on WM_DELETE_WINDOW. The default in | |
974 GTK is to destroy the widget. We want Emacs to do that instead. */ | |
975 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtop), "delete-event", | |
976 G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
977 |
49323 | 978 /* Convert our geometry parameters into a geometry string |
979 and specify it. | |
980 GTK will itself handle calculating the real position this way. */ | |
981 xg_set_geometry (f); | |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
982 f->win_gravity |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
983 = gtk_window_get_gravity (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
49323 | 984 |
985 gtk_widget_add_events (wfixed, | |
986 GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | |
987 | GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | |
988 | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK | |
989 | GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | |
990 | GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK | |
991 | GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK | |
992 | GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK | |
993 | GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK | |
994 | GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK | |
995 | GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_MASK); | |
996 | |
997 /* Must realize the windows so the X window gets created. It is used | |
998 by callers of this function. */ | |
999 gtk_widget_realize (wfixed); | |
1000 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = GTK_WIDGET_TO_X_WIN (wfixed); | |
1001 | |
1002 /* Since GTK clears its window by filling with the background color, | |
1003 we must keep X and GTK background in sync. */ | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
1004 xg_pix_to_gcolor (wfixed, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f), &bg); |
49323 | 1005 gtk_widget_modify_bg (wfixed, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &bg); |
1006 | |
1007 /* Also, do not let any background pixmap to be set, this looks very | |
1008 bad as Emacs overwrites the background pixmap with its own idea | |
1009 of background color. */ | |
1010 style = gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (wfixed); | |
1011 | |
1012 /* Must use g_strdup because gtk_widget_modify_style does g_free. */ | |
1013 style->bg_pixmap_name[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] = g_strdup ("<none>"); | |
1014 gtk_widget_modify_style (wfixed, style); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1015 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1016 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1017 /* Steal a tool tip window we can move ourselves. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1018 f->output_data.x->ttip_widget = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1019 f->output_data.x->ttip_lbl = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1020 f->output_data.x->ttip_window = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1021 gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (wtop, "Dummy text"); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1022 g_signal_connect (wtop, "query-tooltip", G_CALLBACK (qttip_cb), f); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1023 #endif |
49323 | 1024 |
1025 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1026 | |
1027 return 1; | |
1028 } | |
1029 | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1030 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1031 xg_free_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1032 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1033 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1034 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1035 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1036 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1037 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow in xterm.c */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1038 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1039 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1040 if (x->ttip_lbl) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1041 gtk_widget_destroy (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1042 if (x->ttip_widget) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1043 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_widget)); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1044 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1045 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1046 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1047 |
49323 | 1048 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F. |
1049 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags | |
1050 that the window now has. | |
1051 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the User Position | |
1052 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1053 |
49323 | 1054 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1055 x_wm_set_size_hint (FRAME_PTR f, long int flags, int user_position) |
49323 | 1056 { |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1057 /* Must use GTK routines here, otherwise GTK resets the size hints |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1058 to its own defaults. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1059 GdkGeometry size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1060 gint hint_flags = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1061 int base_width, base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1062 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1063 int win_gravity = f->win_gravity; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1064 |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1065 /* Don't set size hints during initialization; that apparently leads |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1066 to a race condition. See the thread at |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1067 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2008-10/msg00033.html */ |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1068 if (NILP (Vafter_init_time) || !FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1069 return; |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1070 |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1071 if (flags) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1072 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1073 memset (&size_hints, 0, sizeof (size_hints)); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1074 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1075 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1076 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1077 else |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1078 flags = f->size_hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1079 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1080 size_hints = f->output_data.x->size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1081 hint_flags = f->output_data.x->hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1082 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1083 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_RESIZE_INC | GDK_HINT_MIN_SIZE; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1084 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1085 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1086 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1087 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_BASE_SIZE; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1088 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1089 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1090 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1091 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1092 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1093 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1094 size_hints.base_width = base_width; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1095 size_hints.base_height = base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1096 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1097 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1098 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1099 /* These currently have a one to one mapping with the X values, but I |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1100 don't think we should rely on that. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1101 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_WIN_GRAVITY; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1102 size_hints.win_gravity = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1103 if (win_gravity == NorthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1104 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1105 else if (win_gravity == NorthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1106 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1107 else if (win_gravity == NorthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1108 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1109 else if (win_gravity == WestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1110 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1111 else if (win_gravity == CenterGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1112 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_CENTER; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1113 else if (win_gravity == EastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1114 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1115 else if (win_gravity == SouthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1116 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1117 else if (win_gravity == SouthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1118 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1119 else if (win_gravity == SouthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1120 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1121 else if (win_gravity == StaticGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1122 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_STATIC; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1123 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1124 if (user_position) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1125 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1126 hint_flags &= ~GDK_HINT_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1127 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_USER_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1128 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1129 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1130 if (hint_flags != f->output_data.x->hint_flags |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1131 || memcmp (&size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1132 &f->output_data.x->size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1133 sizeof (size_hints)) != 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1134 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1135 BLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1136 gtk_window_set_geometry_hints (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1137 NULL, &size_hints, hint_flags); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1138 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1139 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1140 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1141 } |
49323 | 1142 } |
1143 | |
1144 /* Change background color of a frame. | |
96363
f9d35151b907
American English spelling fix.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
95954
diff
changeset
|
1145 Since GTK uses the background color to clear the window, we must |
49323 | 1146 keep the GTK and X colors in sync. |
1147 F is the frame to change, | |
1148 BG is the pixel value to change to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1149 |
49323 | 1150 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1151 xg_set_background_color (FRAME_PTR f, long unsigned int bg) |
49323 | 1152 { |
1153 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) | |
1154 { | |
1155 GdkColor gdk_bg; | |
1156 | |
1157 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
1158 xg_pix_to_gcolor (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), bg, &gdk_bg); | |
1159 gtk_widget_modify_bg (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &gdk_bg); | |
1160 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1161 } | |
1162 } | |
1163 | |
1164 | |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1165 /* Set the frame icon to ICON_PIXMAP/MASK. This must be done with GTK |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1166 functions so GTK does not overwrite the icon. */ |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1167 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1168 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1169 xg_set_frame_icon (FRAME_PTR f, Pixmap icon_pixmap, Pixmap icon_mask) |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1170 { |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1171 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1172 GdkPixmap *gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_pixmap); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1173 GdkPixmap *gmask = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_mask); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1174 GdkPixbuf *gp = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, NULL); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1175 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1176 gtk_window_set_icon (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), gp); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1177 } |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1178 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1179 |
49323 | 1180 |
1181 /*********************************************************************** | |
1182 Dialog functions | |
1183 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1184 /* Return the dialog title to use for a dialog of type KEY. | |
1185 This is the encoding used by lwlib. We use the same for GTK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1186 |
49323 | 1187 static char * |
1188 get_dialog_title (char key) | |
1189 { | |
1190 char *title = ""; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1191 |
49323 | 1192 switch (key) { |
1193 case 'E': case 'e': | |
1194 title = "Error"; | |
1195 break; | |
1196 | |
1197 case 'I': case 'i': | |
1198 title = "Information"; | |
1199 break; | |
1200 | |
1201 case 'L': case 'l': | |
1202 title = "Prompt"; | |
1203 break; | |
1204 | |
1205 case 'P': case 'p': | |
1206 title = "Prompt"; | |
1207 break; | |
1208 | |
1209 case 'Q': case 'q': | |
1210 title = "Question"; | |
1211 break; | |
1212 } | |
1213 | |
1214 return title; | |
1215 } | |
1216 | |
1217 /* Callback for dialogs that get WM_DELETE_WINDOW. We pop down | |
1218 the dialog, but return TRUE so the event does not propagate further | |
1219 in GTK. This prevents GTK from destroying the dialog widget automatically | |
1220 and we can always destrou the widget manually, regardles of how | |
1221 it was popped down (button press or WM_DELETE_WINDOW). | |
1222 W is the dialog widget. | |
1223 EVENT is the GdkEvent that represents WM_DELETE_WINDOW (not used). | |
1224 user_data is NULL (not used). | |
1225 | |
1226 Returns TRUE to end propagation of event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1227 |
49323 | 1228 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1229 dialog_delete_callback (GtkWidget *w, GdkEvent *event, gpointer user_data) |
49323 | 1230 { |
1231 gtk_widget_unmap (w); | |
1232 return TRUE; | |
1233 } | |
1234 | |
1235 /* Create a popup dialog window. See also xg_create_widget below. | |
1236 WV is a widget_value describing the dialog. | |
1237 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a button has been pressed. | |
1238 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when the dialog pops down. | |
1239 | |
1240 Returns the GTK dialog widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1241 |
49323 | 1242 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1243 create_dialog (widget_value *wv, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1244 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1245 GCallback deactivate_cb) |
49323 | 1246 { |
1247 char *title = get_dialog_title (wv->name[0]); | |
1248 int total_buttons = wv->name[1] - '0'; | |
1249 int right_buttons = wv->name[4] - '0'; | |
1250 int left_buttons; | |
1251 int button_nr = 0; | |
1252 int button_spacing = 10; | |
1253 GtkWidget *wdialog = gtk_dialog_new (); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1254 GtkDialog *wd = GTK_DIALOG (wdialog); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1255 GtkBox *cur_box = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_action_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1256 widget_value *item; |
1257 GtkWidget *wvbox; | |
1258 GtkWidget *whbox_up; | |
1259 GtkWidget *whbox_down; | |
1260 | |
1261 /* If the number of buttons is greater than 4, make two rows of buttons | |
1262 instead. This looks better. */ | |
1263 int make_two_rows = total_buttons > 4; | |
1264 | |
1265 if (right_buttons == 0) right_buttons = total_buttons/2; | |
1266 left_buttons = total_buttons - right_buttons; | |
1267 | |
1268 gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wdialog), title); | |
1269 gtk_widget_set_name (wdialog, "emacs-dialog"); | |
1270 | |
1271 | |
1272 if (make_two_rows) | |
1273 { | |
1274 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1275 whbox_up = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1276 whbox_down = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1277 | |
1278 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, wvbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1279 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_up, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1280 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_down, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1281 | |
1282 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_up); | |
1283 } | |
1284 | |
1285 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "delete-event", | |
1286 G_CALLBACK (dialog_delete_callback), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1287 |
49323 | 1288 if (deactivate_cb) |
1289 { | |
1290 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "close", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1291 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "response", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1292 } | |
1293 | |
1294 for (item = wv->contents; item; item = item->next) | |
1295 { | |
1296 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->value); | |
1297 GtkWidget *w; | |
1298 GtkRequisition req; | |
1299 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1300 if (item->name && strcmp (item->name, "message") == 0) |
49323 | 1301 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1302 GtkBox *wvbox = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_content_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1303 /* This is the text part of the dialog. */ |
1304 w = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1305 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, gtk_label_new (""), FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1306 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, w, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 1307 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (w), 0.1, 0.5); |
1308 | |
1309 /* Try to make dialog look better. Must realize first so | |
1310 the widget can calculate the size it needs. */ | |
1311 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
1312 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1313 gtk_box_set_spacing (wvbox, req.height); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1314 if (item->value && strlen (item->value) > 0) |
49323 | 1315 button_spacing = 2*req.width/strlen (item->value); |
1316 } | |
1317 else | |
1318 { | |
1319 /* This is one button to add to the dialog. */ | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
1320 w = gtk_button_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 1321 if (! item->enabled) |
1322 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
1323 if (select_cb) | |
1324 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "clicked", | |
1325 select_cb, item->call_data); | |
1326 | |
1327 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, w, TRUE, TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1328 if (++button_nr == left_buttons) | |
1329 { | |
1330 if (make_two_rows) | |
1331 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_down); | |
1332 else | |
1333 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, | |
1334 gtk_label_new (""), | |
1335 TRUE, TRUE, | |
1336 button_spacing); | |
1337 } | |
1338 } | |
1339 | |
1340 if (utf8_label && utf8_label != item->value) | |
1341 g_free (utf8_label); | |
1342 } | |
1343 | |
1344 return wdialog; | |
1345 } | |
1346 | |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1347 struct xg_dialog_data |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1348 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1349 GMainLoop *loop; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1350 int response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1351 GtkWidget *w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1352 guint timerid; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1353 }; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1354 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1355 /* Function that is called when the file or font dialogs pop down. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1356 W is the dialog widget, RESPONSE is the response code. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1357 USER_DATA is what we passed in to g_signal_connect. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1358 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1359 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1360 xg_dialog_response_cb (GtkDialog *w, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1361 gint response, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1362 gpointer user_data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1363 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1364 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *)user_data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1365 dd->response = response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1366 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1367 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1368 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1369 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1370 /* Destroy the dialog. This makes it pop down. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1371 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1372 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1373 pop_down_dialog (Lisp_Object arg) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1374 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1375 struct Lisp_Save_Value *p = XSAVE_VALUE (arg); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1376 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) p->pointer; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1377 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1378 BLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1379 if (dd->w) gtk_widget_destroy (dd->w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1380 if (dd->timerid != 0) g_source_remove (dd->timerid); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1381 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1382 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1383 g_main_loop_unref (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1384 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1385 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1386 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1387 return Qnil; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1388 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1389 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1390 /* If there are any emacs timers pending, add a timeout to main loop in DATA. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1391 We pass in DATA as gpointer* so we can use this as a callback. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1392 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1393 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1394 xg_maybe_add_timer (gpointer data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1395 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1396 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1397 EMACS_TIME next_time = timer_check (1); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1398 long secs = EMACS_SECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1399 long usecs = EMACS_USECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1400 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1401 dd->timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1402 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1403 if (secs >= 0 && usecs >= 0 && secs < ((guint)-1)/1000) |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1404 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1405 dd->timerid = g_timeout_add (secs * 1000 + usecs/1000, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1406 xg_maybe_add_timer, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1407 dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1408 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1409 return FALSE; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1410 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1411 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1412 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1413 /* Pops up a modal dialog W and waits for response. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1414 We don't use gtk_dialog_run because we want to process emacs timers. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1415 The dialog W is not destroyed when this function returns. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1416 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1417 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1418 xg_dialog_run (FRAME_PTR f, GtkWidget *w) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1419 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1420 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX (); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1421 struct xg_dialog_data dd; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1422 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1423 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1424 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1425 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1426 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1427 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1428 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1429 dd.loop = g_main_loop_new (NULL, FALSE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1430 dd.response = GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1431 dd.w = w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1432 dd.timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1433 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1434 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1435 "response", |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1436 G_CALLBACK (xg_dialog_response_cb), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1437 &dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1438 /* Don't destroy the widget if closed by the window manager close button. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1439 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "delete-event", G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), NULL); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1440 gtk_widget_show (w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1441 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1442 record_unwind_protect (pop_down_dialog, make_save_value (&dd, 0)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1443 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1444 (void) xg_maybe_add_timer (&dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1445 g_main_loop_run (dd.loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1446 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1447 dd.w = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1448 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1449 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1450 return dd.response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1451 } |
49323 | 1452 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1453 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1454 /*********************************************************************** |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1455 File dialog functions |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1456 ***********************************************************************/ |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1457 /* Return non-zero if the old file selection dialog is being used. |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1458 Return zero if not. */ |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1459 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1460 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1461 xg_uses_old_file_dialog (void) |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1462 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1463 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
72963
e5e5fcf4397e
* gtkutil.c (xg_uses_old_file_dialog): Rename x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72931
diff
changeset
|
1464 extern int x_gtk_use_old_file_dialog; |
e5e5fcf4397e
* gtkutil.c (xg_uses_old_file_dialog): Rename x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72931
diff
changeset
|
1465 return x_gtk_use_old_file_dialog; |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1466 #else |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1467 return 0; |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1468 #endif |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1469 } |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1470 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1471 |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
1472 typedef char * (*xg_get_file_func) (GtkWidget *); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1473 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1474 /* Return the selected file for file chooser dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1475 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1476 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1477 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1478 xg_get_file_name_from_chooser (GtkWidget *w) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1479 { |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1480 return gtk_file_chooser_get_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (w)); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1481 } |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1482 |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1483 /* Callback called when the "Show hidden files" toggle is pressed. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1484 WIDGET is the toggle widget, DATA is the file chooser dialog. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1485 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1486 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1487 xg_toggle_visibility_cb (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1488 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1489 GtkFileChooser *dialog = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (data); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1490 gboolean visible; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1491 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1492 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", !visible, NULL); |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1493 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1494 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1495 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1496 /* Callback called when a property changes in a file chooser. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1497 GOBJECT is the file chooser dialog, ARG1 describes the property. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1498 USER_DATA is the toggle widget in the file chooser dialog. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1499 We use this to update the "Show hidden files" toggle when the user |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1500 changes that property by right clicking in the file list. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1501 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1502 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1503 xg_toggle_notify_cb (GObject *gobject, GParamSpec *arg1, gpointer user_data) |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1504 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1505 extern int x_gtk_show_hidden_files; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1506 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1507 if (strcmp (arg1->name, "show-hidden") == 0) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1508 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1509 GtkWidget *wtoggle = GTK_WIDGET (user_data); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1510 gboolean visible, toggle_on; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1511 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1512 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (gobject), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1513 toggle_on = gtk_toggle_button_get_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle)); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1514 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1515 if (!!visible != !!toggle_on) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1516 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1517 g_signal_handlers_block_by_func (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1518 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1519 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1520 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), visible); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1521 g_signal_handlers_unblock_by_func |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1522 (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1523 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1524 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1525 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1526 x_gtk_show_hidden_files = visible; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1527 } |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1528 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1529 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1530 /* Read a file name from the user using a file chooser dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1531 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1532 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1533 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1534 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1535 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1536 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1537 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1538 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1539 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1540 static GtkWidget * |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1541 xg_get_file_with_chooser (FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1542 char *prompt, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1543 char *default_filename, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1544 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1545 xg_get_file_func *func) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1546 { |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1547 char message[1024]; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1548 |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1549 GtkWidget *filewin, *wtoggle, *wbox, *wmessage; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1550 GtkWindow *gwin = GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1551 GtkFileChooserAction action = (mustmatch_p ? |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1552 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_OPEN : |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1553 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1554 extern int x_gtk_show_hidden_files; |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1555 extern int x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text; |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1556 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1557 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1558 if (only_dir_p) |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1559 action = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SELECT_FOLDER; |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1560 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1561 filewin = gtk_file_chooser_dialog_new (prompt, gwin, action, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1562 GTK_STOCK_CANCEL, GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1563 (mustmatch_p || only_dir_p ? |
57900
a76858072e78
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Use GTK_STOCK_OK instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57868
diff
changeset
|
1564 GTK_STOCK_OPEN : GTK_STOCK_OK), |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1565 GTK_RESPONSE_OK, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1566 NULL); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1567 gtk_file_chooser_set_local_only (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), TRUE); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1568 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1569 wbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1570 gtk_widget_show (wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1571 wtoggle = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Show hidden files."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1572 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1573 if (x_gtk_show_hidden_files) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1574 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1575 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (filewin), "show-hidden", TRUE, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1576 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), TRUE); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1577 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1578 gtk_widget_show (wtoggle); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1579 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), "clicked", |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1580 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), filewin); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1581 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (filewin), "notify", |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1582 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_notify_cb), wtoggle); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1583 |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1584 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1585 { |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1586 message[0] = '\0'; |
73048
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1587 /* Gtk+ 2.10 has the file name text entry box integrated in the dialog. |
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1588 Show the C-l help text only for versions < 2.10. */ |
73066 | 1589 if (gtk_check_version (2, 10, 0) && action != GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1590 strcat (message, "\nType C-l to display a file name text entry box.\n"); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1591 strcat (message, "\nIf you don't like this file selector, use the " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1592 "corresponding\nkey binding or customize " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1593 "use-file-dialog to turn it off."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1594 |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1595 wmessage = gtk_label_new (message); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1596 gtk_widget_show (wmessage); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1597 } |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1598 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1599 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wtoggle, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1600 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1601 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wmessage, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1602 gtk_file_chooser_set_extra_widget (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1603 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1604 if (default_filename) |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1605 { |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1606 Lisp_Object file; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1607 struct gcpro gcpro1; |
78781
415fda17ec8f
(xg_get_file_with_chooser): Move GCPRO1 after declarations
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78762
diff
changeset
|
1608 char *utf8_filename; |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1609 GCPRO1 (file); |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1610 |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1611 file = build_string (default_filename); |
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1612 |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1613 /* File chooser does not understand ~/... in the file name. It must be |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1614 an absolute name starting with /. */ |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1615 if (default_filename[0] != '/') |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1616 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1617 |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1618 utf8_filename = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (file)); |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1619 if (! NILP (Ffile_directory_p (file))) |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1620 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_folder (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1621 utf8_filename); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1622 else |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1623 { |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1624 gtk_file_chooser_set_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1625 utf8_filename); |
72637
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1626 if (action == GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1627 { |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1628 char *cp = strrchr (utf8_filename, '/'); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1629 if (cp) ++cp; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1630 else cp = utf8_filename; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1631 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_name (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), cp); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1632 } |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1633 } |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1634 |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1635 UNGCPRO; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1636 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1637 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1638 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_chooser; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1639 return filewin; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1640 } |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1641 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1642 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1643 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1644 /* Return the selected file for file selector dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1645 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1646 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1647 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1648 xg_get_file_name_from_selector (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 1649 { |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1650 GtkFileSelection *filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1651 return xstrdup ((char*) gtk_file_selection_get_filename (filesel)); |
49323 | 1652 } |
1653 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1654 /* Create a file selection dialog. |
49323 | 1655 F is the current frame. |
1656 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. | |
1657 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. | |
1658 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1659 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1660 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1661 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1662 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1663 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1664 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1665 xg_get_file_with_selection (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1666 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1667 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1668 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1669 xg_get_file_func *func) |
49323 | 1670 { |
1671 GtkWidget *filewin; | |
1672 GtkFileSelection *filesel; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1673 |
49323 | 1674 filewin = gtk_file_selection_new (prompt); |
1675 filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (filewin); | |
1676 | |
1677 if (default_filename) | |
1678 gtk_file_selection_set_filename (filesel, default_filename); | |
1679 | |
1680 if (mustmatch_p) | |
1681 { | |
1682 /* The selection_entry part of filesel is not documented. */ | |
1683 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (filesel->selection_entry, FALSE); | |
1684 gtk_file_selection_hide_fileop_buttons (filesel); | |
1685 } | |
1686 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1687 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_selector; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1688 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1689 return filewin; |
49323 | 1690 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1691 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1692 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1693 /* Read a file name from the user using a file dialog, either the old |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1694 file selection dialog, or the new file chooser dialog. Which to use |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1695 depends on what the GTK version used has, and what the value of |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1696 gtk-use-old-file-dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1697 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1698 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1699 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1700 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1701 file. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1702 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1703 Returns a file name or NULL if no file was selected. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1704 The returned string must be freed by the caller. */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1705 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1706 char * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1707 xg_get_file_name (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1708 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1709 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1710 int mustmatch_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1711 int only_dir_p) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1712 { |
58284
10efc827e15c
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Fix typo in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58201
diff
changeset
|
1713 GtkWidget *w = 0; |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1714 char *fn = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1715 int filesel_done = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1716 xg_get_file_func func; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1717 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1718 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1719 /* I really don't know why this is needed, but without this the GLIBC add on |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1720 library linuxthreads hangs when the Gnome file chooser backend creates |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1721 threads. */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1722 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1723 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1724 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1725 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58463
86fddd350b35
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Rename use-old-gtk-file-dialog to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58284
diff
changeset
|
1726 |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1727 if (xg_uses_old_file_dialog ()) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1728 w = xg_get_file_with_selection (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1729 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1730 else |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1731 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1732 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1733 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1734 #else /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1735 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1736 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1737 #endif /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1738 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1739 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-filedialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1740 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1741 filesel_done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1742 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1743 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1744 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1745 #endif |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1746 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1747 if (filesel_done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1748 fn = (*func) (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1749 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1750 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1751 return fn; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1752 } |
49323 | 1753 |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1754 #ifdef HAVE_FREETYPE |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1755 /* Pop up a GTK font selector and return the name of the font the user |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1756 selects, as a C string. The returned font name follows GTK's own |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1757 format: |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1758 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1759 `FAMILY [VALUE1 VALUE2] SIZE' |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1760 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1761 This can be parsed using font_parse_fcname in font.c. |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1762 DEFAULT_NAME, if non-zero, is the default font name. */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1763 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1764 char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1765 xg_get_font_name (FRAME_PTR f, char *default_name) |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1766 { |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1767 GtkWidget *w; |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1768 char *fontname = NULL; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1769 int done = 0; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1770 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1771 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1772 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1773 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1774 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1775 w = gtk_font_selection_dialog_new ("Pick a font"); |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1776 if (!default_name) |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1777 default_name = "Monospace 10"; |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1778 gtk_font_selection_dialog_set_font_name (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w), |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1779 default_name); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1780 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1781 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-fontdialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1782 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1783 done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1784 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1785 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1786 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1787 #endif |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1788 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1789 if (done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1790 fontname = gtk_font_selection_dialog_get_font_name |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1791 (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1792 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1793 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1794 return fontname; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1795 } |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1796 #endif /* HAVE_FREETYPE */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1797 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1798 |
49323 | 1799 |
1800 /*********************************************************************** | |
1801 Menu functions. | |
1802 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1803 | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1804 /* The name of menu items that can be used for customization. Since GTK |
49323 | 1805 RC files are very crude and primitive, we have to set this on all |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1806 menu item names so a user can easily customize menu items. */ |
49323 | 1807 |
1808 #define MENU_ITEM_NAME "emacs-menuitem" | |
1809 | |
1810 | |
1811 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1812 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1813 static xg_list_node xg_menu_cb_list; | |
1814 | |
1815 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_item_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1816 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1817 static xg_list_node xg_menu_item_cb_list; | |
1818 | |
1819 /* Allocate and initialize CL_DATA if NULL, otherwise increase ref_count. | |
1820 F is the frame CL_DATA will be initialized for. | |
1821 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1822 | |
1823 The menu bar and all sub menus under the menu bar in a frame | |
1824 share the same structure, hence the reference count. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1825 |
49323 | 1826 Returns CL_DATA if CL_DATA is not NULL, or a pointer to a newly |
1827 allocated xg_menu_cb_data if CL_DATA is NULL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1828 |
49323 | 1829 static xg_menu_cb_data * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1830 make_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, FRAME_PTR f, GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1831 { |
1832 if (! cl_data) | |
1833 { | |
1834 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) xmalloc (sizeof (*cl_data)); | |
1835 cl_data->f = f; | |
1836 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1837 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1838 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1839 cl_data->ref_count = 0; | |
1840 | |
1841 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1842 } | |
1843 | |
1844 cl_data->ref_count++; | |
1845 | |
1846 return cl_data; | |
1847 } | |
1848 | |
1849 /* Update CL_DATA with values from frame F and with HIGHLIGHT_CB. | |
1850 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1851 | |
1852 When the menu bar is updated, menu items may have been added and/or | |
1853 removed, so menu_bar_vector and menu_bar_items_used change. We must | |
1854 then update CL_DATA since it is used to determine which menu | |
1855 item that is invoked in the menu. | |
1856 HIGHLIGHT_CB could change, there is no check that the same | |
1857 function is given when modifying a menu bar as was given when | |
1858 creating the menu bar. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1859 |
49323 | 1860 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1861 update_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1862 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1863 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1864 { |
1865 if (cl_data) | |
1866 { | |
1867 cl_data->f = f; | |
1868 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1869 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1870 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1871 } | |
1872 } | |
1873 | |
1874 /* Decrease reference count for CL_DATA. | |
1875 If reference count is zero, free CL_DATA. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1876 |
49323 | 1877 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1878 unref_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 1879 { |
1880 if (cl_data && cl_data->ref_count > 0) | |
1881 { | |
1882 cl_data->ref_count--; | |
1883 if (cl_data->ref_count == 0) | |
1884 { | |
1885 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1886 xfree (cl_data); | |
1887 } | |
1888 } | |
1889 } | |
1890 | |
1891 /* Function that marks all lisp data during GC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1892 |
49323 | 1893 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1894 xg_mark_data (void) |
49323 | 1895 { |
1896 xg_list_node *iter; | |
1897 | |
1898 for (iter = xg_menu_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1899 mark_object (((xg_menu_cb_data *) iter)->menu_bar_vector); |
49323 | 1900 |
1901 for (iter = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
1902 { | |
1903 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) iter; | |
1904 | |
1905 if (! NILP (cb_data->help)) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1906 mark_object (cb_data->help); |
49323 | 1907 } |
1908 } | |
1909 | |
1910 | |
1911 /* Callback called when a menu item is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
1912 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
1913 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_item_cb_data associated with the W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1914 |
49323 | 1915 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1916 menuitem_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 1917 { |
1918 if (client_data) | |
1919 { | |
1920 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) client_data; | |
1921 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &data->ptrs); | |
1922 xfree (data); | |
1923 } | |
1924 } | |
1925 | |
1926 /* Callback called when the pointer enters/leaves a menu item. | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1927 W is the parent of the menu item. |
49323 | 1928 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1929 CLIENT_DATA is not used. |
49323 | 1930 |
1931 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1932 |
49323 | 1933 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1934 menuitem_highlight_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1935 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1936 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 1937 { |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1938 GdkEvent ev; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1939 GtkWidget *subwidget; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1940 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1941 |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1942 ev.crossing = *event; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1943 subwidget = gtk_get_event_widget (&ev); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1944 data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (subwidget), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1945 XG_ITEM_DATA); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1946 if (data) |
49323 | 1947 { |
1948 if (! NILP (data->help) && data->cl_data->highlight_cb) | |
1949 { | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1950 gpointer call_data = event->type == GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY ? 0 : data; |
49323 | 1951 GtkCallback func = (GtkCallback) data->cl_data->highlight_cb; |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
1952 (*func) (subwidget, call_data); |
49323 | 1953 } |
1954 } | |
1955 | |
1956 return FALSE; | |
1957 } | |
1958 | |
1959 /* Callback called when a menu is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
1960 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
1961 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_cb_data associated with W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1962 |
49323 | 1963 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1964 menu_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 1965 { |
1966 unref_cl_data ((xg_menu_cb_data*) client_data); | |
1967 } | |
1968 | |
1969 /* Make a GTK widget that contains both UTF8_LABEL and UTF8_KEY (both | |
1970 must be non-NULL) and can be inserted into a menu item. | |
1971 | |
1972 Returns the GtkHBox. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1973 |
49323 | 1974 static GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1975 make_widget_for_menu_item (char *utf8_label, char *utf8_key) |
49323 | 1976 { |
1977 GtkWidget *wlbl; | |
1978 GtkWidget *wkey; | |
1979 GtkWidget *wbox; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1980 |
49323 | 1981 wbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
1982 wlbl = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); |
49323 | 1983 wkey = gtk_label_new (utf8_key); |
1984 | |
1985 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wlbl), 0.0, 0.5); | |
1986 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wkey), 0.0, 0.5); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1987 |
49323 | 1988 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wlbl, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
1989 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wkey, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1990 | |
1991 gtk_widget_set_name (wlbl, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
1992 gtk_widget_set_name (wkey, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1993 gtk_widget_set_name (wbox, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
49323 | 1994 |
1995 return wbox; | |
1996 } | |
1997 | |
1998 /* Make and return a menu item widget with the key to the right. | |
1999 UTF8_LABEL is the text for the menu item (GTK uses UTF8 internally). | |
2000 UTF8_KEY is the text representing the key binding. | |
2001 ITEM is the widget_value describing the menu item. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2002 |
49323 | 2003 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not |
2004 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2005 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2006 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2007 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2008 | |
2009 Unfortunately, keys don't line up as nicely as in Motif, | |
2010 but the MacOS X version doesn't either, so I guess that is OK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2011 |
49323 | 2012 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2013 make_menu_item (char *utf8_label, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2014 char *utf8_key, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2015 widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2016 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2017 { |
2018 GtkWidget *w; | |
2019 GtkWidget *wtoadd = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2020 |
51432
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2021 /* It has been observed that some menu items have a NULL name field. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2022 This will lead to this function being called with a NULL utf8_label. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2023 GTK crashes on that so we set a blank label. Why there is a NULL |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2024 name remains to be investigated. */ |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2025 if (! utf8_label) utf8_label = " "; |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2026 |
49323 | 2027 if (utf8_key) |
2028 wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2029 |
49323 | 2030 if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) |
2031 { | |
2032 *group = NULL; | |
2033 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_check_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2034 else w = gtk_check_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2035 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), item->selected); |
2036 } | |
2037 else if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2038 { | |
2039 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new (*group); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2040 else w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new_with_label (*group, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2041 *group = gtk_radio_menu_item_get_group (GTK_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)); |
2042 if (item->selected) | |
2043 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), TRUE); | |
2044 } | |
2045 else | |
2046 { | |
2047 *group = NULL; | |
2048 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2049 else w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2050 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2051 |
49323 | 2052 if (wtoadd) gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); |
2053 if (! item->enabled) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
2054 | |
2055 return w; | |
2056 } | |
2057 | |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2058 /* Return non-zero if LABEL specifies a separator (GTK only has one |
49323 | 2059 separator type) */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2060 |
105959
ba3ffbd9c422
* process.c (ifflag_def): Make flag_sym constant.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105936
diff
changeset
|
2061 static const char* separator_names[] = { |
78787
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2062 "space", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2063 "no-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2064 "single-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2065 "double-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2066 "single-dashed-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2067 "double-dashed-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2068 "shadow-etched-in", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2069 "shadow-etched-out", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2070 "shadow-etched-in-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2071 "shadow-etched-out-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2072 "shadow-double-etched-in", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2073 "shadow-double-etched-out", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2074 "shadow-double-etched-in-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2075 "shadow-double-etched-out-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2076 0, |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2077 }; |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2078 |
49323 | 2079 static int |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2080 xg_separator_p (char *label) |
49323 | 2081 { |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2082 if (! label) return 0; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2083 else if (strlen (label) > 3 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2084 && strncmp (label, "--", 2) == 0 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2085 && label[2] != '-') |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2086 { |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2087 int i; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2088 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2089 label += 2; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2090 for (i = 0; separator_names[i]; ++i) |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2091 if (strcmp (label, separator_names[i]) == 0) |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2092 return 1; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2093 } |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2094 else |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2095 { |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2096 /* Old-style separator, maybe. It's a separator if it contains |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2097 only dashes. */ |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2098 while (*label == '-') |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2099 ++label; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2100 if (*label == 0) return 1; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2101 } |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2102 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2103 return 0; |
49323 | 2104 } |
2105 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2106 static int xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2107 |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2108 /* Returns non-zero if there are detached menus. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2109 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2110 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2111 xg_have_tear_offs (void) |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2112 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2113 return xg_detached_menus > 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2114 } |
49323 | 2115 |
2116 /* Callback invoked when a detached menu window is removed. Here we | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2117 decrease the xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2118 WIDGET is the top level window that is removed (the parent of the menu). |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2119 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2120 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2121 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2122 tearoff_remove (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2123 { |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2124 if (xg_detached_menus > 0) --xg_detached_menus; |
49323 | 2125 } |
2126 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2127 /* Callback invoked when a menu is detached. It increases the |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2128 xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2129 WIDGET is the GtkTearoffMenuItem. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2130 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2131 |
49323 | 2132 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2133 tearoff_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2134 { |
2135 GtkWidget *menu = gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2136 if (gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (menu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2137 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2138 ++xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2139 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget)), |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2140 "destroy", |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2141 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_remove), 0); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2142 } |
49323 | 2143 } |
2144 | |
2145 | |
2146 /* Create a menu item widget, and connect the callbacks. | |
2147 ITEM decribes the menu item. | |
2148 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2149 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2150 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2151 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu. | |
2152 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not | |
2153 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2154 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2155 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2156 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2157 | |
2158 Returns the created GtkWidget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2159 |
49323 | 2160 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2161 xg_create_one_menuitem (widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2162 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2163 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2164 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2165 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2166 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2167 { |
2168 char *utf8_label; | |
2169 char *utf8_key; | |
2170 GtkWidget *w; | |
2171 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; | |
2172 | |
2173 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2174 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (item->key); | |
2175 | |
2176 w = make_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key, item, group); | |
2177 | |
2178 if (utf8_label && utf8_label != item->name) g_free (utf8_label); | |
2179 if (utf8_key && utf8_key != item->key) g_free (utf8_key); | |
2180 | |
2181 cb_data = xmalloc (sizeof (xg_menu_item_cb_data)); | |
2182 | |
2183 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &cb_data->ptrs); | |
2184 | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2185 cb_data->select_id = 0; |
49323 | 2186 cb_data->help = item->help; |
2187 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
2188 cb_data->call_data = item->call_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2189 |
49323 | 2190 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
2191 "destroy", | |
2192 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_destroy_callback), | |
2193 cb_data); | |
2194 | |
2195 /* Put cb_data in widget, so we can get at it when modifying menubar */ | |
2196 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_ITEM_DATA, cb_data); | |
2197 | |
2198 /* final item, not a submenu */ | |
2199 if (item->call_data && ! item->contents) | |
2200 { | |
2201 if (select_cb) | |
2202 cb_data->select_id | |
2203 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", select_cb, cb_data); | |
2204 } | |
2205 | |
2206 return w; | |
2207 } | |
2208 | |
2209 /* Create a full menu tree specified by DATA. | |
2210 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2211 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2212 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2213 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2214 POP_UP_P is non-zero if we shall create a popup menu. | |
2215 MENU_BAR_P is non-zero if we shall create a menu bar. | |
2216 ADD_TEAROFF_P is non-zero if we shall add a teroff menu item. Ignored | |
2217 if MENU_BAR_P is non-zero. | |
2218 TOPMENU is the topmost GtkWidget that others shall be placed under. | |
2219 It may be NULL, in that case we create the appropriate widget | |
2220 (menu bar or menu item depending on POP_UP_P and MENU_BAR_P) | |
2221 CL_DATA is the callback data we shall use for this menu, or NULL | |
2222 if we haven't set the first callback yet. | |
2223 NAME is the name to give to the top level menu if this function | |
2224 creates it. May be NULL to not set any name. | |
2225 | |
2226 Returns the top level GtkWidget. This is TOPLEVEL if TOPLEVEL is | |
2227 not NULL. | |
2228 | |
2229 This function calls itself to create submenus. */ | |
2230 | |
2231 static GtkWidget * | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2232 create_menus (widget_value *data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2233 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2234 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2235 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2236 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2237 int pop_up_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2238 int menu_bar_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2239 int add_tearoff_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2240 GtkWidget *topmenu, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2241 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2242 char *name) |
49323 | 2243 { |
2244 widget_value *item; | |
2245 GtkWidget *wmenu = topmenu; | |
2246 GSList *group = NULL; | |
2247 | |
2248 if (! topmenu) | |
2249 { | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2250 if (! menu_bar_p) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2251 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2252 wmenu = gtk_menu_new (); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2253 xg_set_screen (wmenu, f); |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2254 /* Connect this to the menu instead of items so we get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2255 disabled items also. TODO: Still does not get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2256 disabled items in detached menus. */ |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2257 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2258 "enter-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2259 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2260 NULL); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2261 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2262 "leave-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2263 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2264 NULL); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2265 } |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2266 else |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2267 { |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2268 wmenu = gtk_menu_bar_new (); |
106186
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2269 /* Set width of menu bar to a small value so it doesn't enlarge |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2270 a small initial frame size. The width will be set to the |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2271 width of the frame later on when it is added to a container. |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2272 height -1: Natural height. */ |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2273 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wmenu, 1, -1); |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2274 } |
49323 | 2275 |
2276 /* Put cl_data on the top menu for easier access. */ | |
2277 cl_data = make_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
2278 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenu), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)cl_data); | |
2279 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), "destroy", | |
2280 G_CALLBACK (menu_destroy_callback), cl_data); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2281 |
49323 | 2282 if (name) |
2283 gtk_widget_set_name (wmenu, name); | |
2284 | |
2285 if (deactivate_cb) | |
2286 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), | |
59913
b3664fca53d1
* gtkutil.c (create_menus): Connect selection-done event instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59666
diff
changeset
|
2287 "selection-done", deactivate_cb, 0); |
49323 | 2288 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2289 |
49323 | 2290 if (! menu_bar_p && add_tearoff_p) |
2291 { | |
2292 GtkWidget *tearoff = gtk_tearoff_menu_item_new (); | |
2293 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), tearoff); | |
2294 | |
2295 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (tearoff), "activate", | |
2296 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_activate), 0); | |
2297 } | |
2298 | |
2299 for (item = data; item; item = item->next) | |
2300 { | |
2301 GtkWidget *w; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2302 |
49323 | 2303 if (pop_up_p && !item->contents && !item->call_data |
2304 && !xg_separator_p (item->name)) | |
2305 { | |
2306 char *utf8_label; | |
2307 /* A title for a popup. We do the same as GTK does when | |
2308 creating titles, but it does not look good. */ | |
2309 group = NULL; | |
2310 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2311 | |
2312 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (wmenu), utf8_label); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2313 w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2314 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
2315 if (utf8_label && utf8_label != item->name) g_free (utf8_label); | |
2316 } | |
2317 else if (xg_separator_p (item->name)) | |
2318 { | |
2319 group = NULL; | |
2320 /* GTK only have one separator type. */ | |
2321 w = gtk_separator_menu_item_new (); | |
2322 } | |
2323 else | |
2324 { | |
2325 w = xg_create_one_menuitem (item, | |
2326 f, | |
2327 item->contents ? 0 : select_cb, | |
2328 highlight_cb, | |
2329 cl_data, | |
2330 &group); | |
2331 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2332 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2333 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2334 if (item->contents || menu_bar_p) |
49323 | 2335 { |
2336 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (item->contents, | |
2337 f, | |
2338 select_cb, | |
2339 deactivate_cb, | |
2340 highlight_cb, | |
2341 0, | |
2342 0, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2343 add_tearoff_p, |
49323 | 2344 0, |
2345 cl_data, | |
2346 0); | |
2347 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); | |
2348 } | |
2349 } | |
2350 | |
2351 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), w); | |
2352 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
2353 } | |
2354 | |
2355 return wmenu; | |
2356 } | |
2357 | |
2358 /* Create a menubar, popup menu or dialog, depending on the TYPE argument. | |
2359 TYPE can be "menubar", "popup" for popup menu, or "dialog" for a dialog | |
2360 with some text and buttons. | |
2361 F is the frame the created item belongs to. | |
2362 NAME is the name to use for the top widget. | |
2363 VAL is a widget_value structure describing items to be created. | |
2364 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected or | |
2365 a dialog button is pressed. | |
2366 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when an item is deactivated. | |
2367 For a menu, when a sub menu is not shown anymore, for a dialog it is | |
2368 called when the dialog is popped down. | |
2369 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2370 | |
2371 Returns the widget created. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2372 |
49323 | 2373 GtkWidget * |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2374 xg_create_widget (char *type, char *name, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2375 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2376 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 2377 { |
2378 GtkWidget *w = 0; | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2379 int menu_bar_p = strcmp (type, "menubar") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2380 int pop_up_p = strcmp (type, "popup") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2381 |
49323 | 2382 if (strcmp (type, "dialog") == 0) |
2383 { | |
2384 w = create_dialog (val, select_cb, deactivate_cb); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2385 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
49323 | 2386 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
2387 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); | |
2388 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2389 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-dialog"); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
2390 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
49323 | 2391 } |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2392 else if (menu_bar_p || pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2393 { |
2394 w = create_menus (val->contents, | |
2395 f, | |
2396 select_cb, | |
2397 deactivate_cb, | |
2398 highlight_cb, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2399 pop_up_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2400 menu_bar_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2401 menu_bar_p, |
49323 | 2402 0, |
2403 0, | |
2404 name); | |
2405 | |
2406 /* Set the cursor to an arrow for popup menus when they are mapped. | |
2407 This is done by default for menu bar menus. */ | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2408 if (pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2409 { |
2410 /* Must realize so the GdkWindow inside the widget is created. */ | |
2411 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2412 xg_set_cursor (w, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 2413 } |
2414 } | |
2415 else | |
2416 { | |
2417 fprintf (stderr, "bad type in xg_create_widget: %s, doing nothing\n", | |
2418 type); | |
2419 } | |
2420 | |
2421 return w; | |
2422 } | |
2423 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2424 /* Return the label for menu item WITEM. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2425 |
49323 | 2426 static const char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2427 xg_get_menu_item_label (GtkMenuItem *witem) |
49323 | 2428 { |
2429 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (witem))); | |
2430 return gtk_label_get_label (wlabel); | |
2431 } | |
2432 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2433 /* Return non-zero if the menu item WITEM has the text LABEL. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2434 |
49323 | 2435 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2436 xg_item_label_same_p (GtkMenuItem *witem, char *label) |
49323 | 2437 { |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2438 int is_same = 0; |
49323 | 2439 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (label); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2440 const char *old_label = witem ? xg_get_menu_item_label (witem) : 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2441 |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2442 if (! old_label && ! utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2443 is_same = 1; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2444 else if (old_label && utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2445 is_same = strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) == 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2446 |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2447 if (utf8_label && utf8_label != label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2448 |
2449 return is_same; | |
2450 } | |
2451 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2452 /* Destroy widgets in LIST. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2453 |
49323 | 2454 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2455 xg_destroy_widgets (GList *list) |
49323 | 2456 { |
2457 GList *iter; | |
2458 | |
49572 | 2459 for (iter = list; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
49323 | 2460 { |
2461 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2462 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2463 /* Destroying the widget will remove it from the container it is in. */ |
49323 | 2464 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
2465 } | |
2466 } | |
2467 | |
2468 /* Update the top level names in MENUBAR (i.e. not submenus). | |
2469 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
49572 | 2470 *LIST is a list with the current menu bar names (menu item widgets). |
2471 ITER is the item within *LIST that shall be updated. | |
2472 POS is the numerical position, starting at 0, of ITER in *LIST. | |
49323 | 2473 VAL describes what the menu bar shall look like after the update. |
2474 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2475 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
49572 | 2476 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu bar. |
49323 | 2477 |
2478 This function calls itself to walk through the menu bar names. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2479 |
49323 | 2480 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2481 xg_update_menubar (GtkWidget *menubar, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2482 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2483 GList **list, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2484 GList *iter, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2485 int pos, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2486 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2487 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2488 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2489 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2490 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2491 { |
49572 | 2492 if (! iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2493 return; |
49572 | 2494 else if (iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2495 { |
49572 | 2496 /* Item(s) have been removed. Remove all remaining items. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2497 xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2498 |
106161
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2499 /* Add a blank entry so the menubar doesn't collapse to nothing. */ |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2500 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2501 gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (""), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2502 0); |
49323 | 2503 /* All updated. */ |
2504 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2505 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2506 } |
49572 | 2507 else if (! iter && val) |
49323 | 2508 { |
2509 /* Item(s) added. Add all new items in one call. */ | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2510 create_menus (val, f, select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, |
49323 | 2511 0, 1, 0, menubar, cl_data, 0); |
2512 | |
2513 /* All updated. */ | |
2514 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2515 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2516 } |
49572 | 2517 /* Below this neither iter or val is NULL */ |
2518 else if (xg_item_label_same_p (GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data), val->name)) | |
49323 | 2519 { |
2520 /* This item is still the same, check next item. */ | |
2521 val = val->next; | |
49572 | 2522 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
2523 ++pos; | |
49323 | 2524 } |
2525 else /* This item is changed. */ | |
2526 { | |
49572 | 2527 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); |
49323 | 2528 GtkMenuItem *witem2 = 0; |
2529 int val_in_menubar = 0; | |
49572 | 2530 int iter_in_new_menubar = 0; |
2531 GList *iter2; | |
49323 | 2532 widget_value *cur; |
2533 | |
2534 /* See if the changed entry (val) is present later in the menu bar */ | |
49572 | 2535 for (iter2 = iter; |
2536 iter2 && ! val_in_menubar; | |
2537 iter2 = g_list_next (iter2)) | |
49323 | 2538 { |
49572 | 2539 witem2 = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter2->data); |
49323 | 2540 val_in_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem2, val->name); |
2541 } | |
2542 | |
49572 | 2543 /* See if the current entry (iter) is present later in the |
49323 | 2544 specification for the new menu bar. */ |
49572 | 2545 for (cur = val; cur && ! iter_in_new_menubar; cur = cur->next) |
2546 iter_in_new_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name); | |
2547 | |
2548 if (val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) | |
49323 | 2549 { |
49572 | 2550 int nr = pos; |
2551 | |
49323 | 2552 /* This corresponds to: |
2553 Current: A B C | |
2554 New: A C | |
2555 Remove B. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2556 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2557 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem)); |
49323 | 2558 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem)); |
2559 gtk_widget_destroy (GTK_WIDGET (witem)); | |
2560 | |
2561 /* Must get new list since the old changed. */ | |
49572 | 2562 g_list_free (*list); |
2563 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2564 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2565 } |
49572 | 2566 else if (! val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2567 { |
2568 /* This corresponds to: | |
2569 Current: A B C | |
2570 New: A X C | |
2571 Rename B to X. This might seem to be a strange thing to do, | |
2572 since if there is a menu under B it will be totally wrong for X. | |
2573 But consider editing a C file. Then there is a C-mode menu | |
2574 (corresponds to B above). | |
2575 If then doing C-x C-f the minibuf menu (X above) replaces the | |
2576 C-mode menu. When returning from the minibuffer, we get | |
2577 back the C-mode menu. Thus we do: | |
2578 Rename B to X (C-mode to minibuf menu) | |
2579 Rename X to B (minibuf to C-mode menu). | |
2580 If the X menu hasn't been invoked, the menu under B | |
2581 is up to date when leaving the minibuffer. */ | |
2582 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (witem))); | |
2583 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2584 GtkWidget *submenu = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2585 |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2586 gtk_label_set_text (wlabel, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2587 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2588 /* If this item has a submenu that has been detached, change |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2589 the title in the WM decorations also. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2590 if (submenu && gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (submenu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2591 /* Set the title of the detached window. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2592 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (submenu), utf8_label); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2593 |
49572 | 2594 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2595 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2596 ++pos; |
49323 | 2597 } |
49572 | 2598 else if (! val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2599 { |
2600 /* This corresponds to: | |
2601 Current: A B C | |
2602 New: A X B C | |
2603 Insert X. */ | |
2604 | |
49572 | 2605 int nr = pos; |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2606 GSList *group = 0; |
49323 | 2607 GtkWidget *w = xg_create_one_menuitem (val, |
2608 f, | |
2609 select_cb, | |
2610 highlight_cb, | |
2611 cl_data, | |
2612 &group); | |
2613 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2614 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2615 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2616 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (NULL, f, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2617 select_cb, deactivate_cb, |
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2618 highlight_cb, |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2619 0, 0, 0, 0, cl_data, 0); |
49323 | 2620 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
2621 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), w, pos); | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2622 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); |
49323 | 2623 |
49572 | 2624 g_list_free (*list); |
2625 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2626 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2627 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2628 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2629 ++pos; |
49323 | 2630 } |
49572 | 2631 else /* if (val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) */ |
49323 | 2632 { |
49572 | 2633 int nr = pos; |
49323 | 2634 /* This corresponds to: |
2635 Current: A B C | |
2636 New: A C B | |
2637 Move C before B */ | |
2638 | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2639 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2640 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem2)); |
2641 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), | |
2642 GTK_WIDGET (witem2), pos); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2643 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2644 |
49572 | 2645 g_list_free (*list); |
2646 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2647 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
76906
bb6e75c27940
(xg_update_menubar): Call g_list_next after moving
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75576
diff
changeset
|
2648 if (iter) iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2649 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2650 ++pos; |
49323 | 2651 } |
2652 } | |
2653 | |
2654 /* Update the rest of the menu bar. */ | |
49572 | 2655 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, list, iter, pos, val, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2656 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
49323 | 2657 } |
2658 | |
2659 /* Update the menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2660 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2661 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
102358 | 2662 CL_DATA is the data to set in the widget for menu invocation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2663 |
49323 | 2664 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2665 xg_update_menu_item (widget_value *val, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2666 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2667 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2668 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2669 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2670 { |
2671 GtkWidget *wchild; | |
2672 GtkLabel *wlbl = 0; | |
2673 GtkLabel *wkey = 0; | |
2674 char *utf8_label; | |
2675 char *utf8_key; | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2676 const char *old_label = 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2677 const char *old_key = 0; |
49323 | 2678 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2679 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2680 wchild = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (w)); |
49323 | 2681 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); |
2682 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (val->key); | |
2683 | |
2684 /* See if W is a menu item with a key. See make_menu_item above. */ | |
2685 if (GTK_IS_HBOX (wchild)) | |
2686 { | |
2687 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wchild)); | |
2688 | |
2689 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); | |
2690 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2691 g_list_free (list); |
2692 | |
49323 | 2693 if (! utf8_key) |
2694 { | |
2695 /* Remove the key and keep just the label. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2696 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2697 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); |
2698 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), GTK_WIDGET (wlbl)); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2699 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2700 wkey = 0; |
2701 } | |
49572 | 2702 |
49323 | 2703 } |
2704 else /* Just a label. */ | |
2705 { | |
2706 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (wchild); | |
2707 | |
2708 /* Check if there is now a key. */ | |
2709 if (utf8_key) | |
2710 { | |
2711 GtkWidget *wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
2712 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoadd)); | |
49572 | 2713 |
49323 | 2714 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); |
2715 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2716 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 2717 |
2718 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); | |
2719 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); | |
2720 } | |
2721 } | |
2722 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2723 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2724 if (wkey) old_key = gtk_label_get_label (wkey); |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2725 if (wlbl) old_label = gtk_label_get_label (wlbl); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2726 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2727 if (wkey && utf8_key && (! old_key || strcmp (utf8_key, old_key) != 0)) |
49323 | 2728 gtk_label_set_text (wkey, utf8_key); |
2729 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2730 if (! old_label || strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) != 0) |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2731 gtk_label_set_text (wlbl, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2732 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2733 if (utf8_key && utf8_key != val->key) g_free (utf8_key); |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2734 if (utf8_label && utf8_label != val->name) g_free (utf8_label); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2735 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2736 if (! val->enabled && gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2737 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2738 else if (val->enabled && ! gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2739 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, TRUE); |
2740 | |
2741 cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), | |
2742 XG_ITEM_DATA); | |
2743 if (cb_data) | |
2744 { | |
2745 cb_data->call_data = val->call_data; | |
2746 cb_data->help = val->help; | |
2747 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2748 |
49323 | 2749 /* We assume the callback functions don't change. */ |
2750 if (val->call_data && ! val->contents) | |
2751 { | |
2752 /* This item shall have a select callback. */ | |
2753 if (! cb_data->select_id) | |
2754 cb_data->select_id | |
2755 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", | |
2756 select_cb, cb_data); | |
2757 } | |
2758 else if (cb_data->select_id) | |
2759 { | |
2760 g_signal_handler_disconnect (w, cb_data->select_id); | |
2761 cb_data->select_id = 0; | |
2762 } | |
2763 } | |
2764 } | |
2765 | |
2766 /* Update the toggle menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2767 |
49323 | 2768 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2769 xg_update_toggle_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2770 { |
2771 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2772 } | |
2773 | |
2774 /* Update the radio menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2775 |
49323 | 2776 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2777 xg_update_radio_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2778 { |
2779 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2780 } | |
2781 | |
2782 /* Update the sub menu SUBMENU and all its children so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2783 SUBMENU may be NULL, in that case a new menu is created. | |
2784 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
2785 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
2786 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2787 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2788 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2789 CL_DATA is the call back data to use for any newly created items. | |
2790 | |
2791 Returns the updated submenu widget, that is SUBMENU unless SUBMENU | |
2792 was NULL. */ | |
2793 | |
2794 static GtkWidget * | |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2795 xg_update_submenu (GtkWidget *submenu, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2796 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2797 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2798 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2799 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2800 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2801 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2802 { |
2803 GtkWidget *newsub = submenu; | |
2804 GList *list = 0; | |
2805 GList *iter; | |
2806 widget_value *cur; | |
2807 int has_tearoff_p = 0; | |
2808 GList *first_radio = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2809 |
49323 | 2810 if (submenu) |
2811 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (submenu)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2812 |
49323 | 2813 for (cur = val, iter = list; |
2814 cur && iter; | |
2815 iter = g_list_next (iter), cur = cur->next) | |
2816 { | |
2817 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2818 | |
2819 /* Skip tearoff items, they have no counterpart in val. */ | |
2820 if (GTK_IS_TEAROFF_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2821 { | |
2822 has_tearoff_p = 1; | |
2823 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2824 if (iter) w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2825 else break; | |
2826 } | |
2827 | |
2828 /* Remember first radio button in a group. If we get a mismatch in | |
2829 a radio group we must rebuild the whole group so that the connections | |
2830 in GTK becomes correct. */ | |
2831 if (cur->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO && ! first_radio) | |
2832 first_radio = iter; | |
2833 else if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO | |
2834 && ! GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2835 first_radio = 0; | |
2836 | |
2837 if (GTK_IS_SEPARATOR_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2838 { | |
2839 if (! xg_separator_p (cur->name)) | |
2840 break; | |
2841 } | |
2842 else if (GTK_IS_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2843 { | |
2844 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) | |
2845 break; | |
2846 xg_update_toggle_item (cur, w); | |
2847 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2848 } | |
2849 else if (GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2850 { | |
2851 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2852 break; | |
2853 xg_update_radio_item (cur, w); | |
2854 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2855 } | |
2856 else if (GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2857 { | |
2858 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (w); | |
2859 GtkWidget *sub; | |
2860 | |
2861 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_NONE || | |
2862 xg_separator_p (cur->name)) | |
2863 break; | |
2864 | |
2865 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2866 | |
2867 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
2868 if (sub && ! cur->contents) | |
2869 { | |
2870 /* Not a submenu anymore. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2871 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (sub)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2872 remove_submenu (witem); |
49323 | 2873 gtk_widget_destroy (sub); |
2874 } | |
2875 else if (cur->contents) | |
2876 { | |
2877 GtkWidget *nsub; | |
2878 | |
2879 nsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, f, cur->contents, | |
2880 select_cb, deactivate_cb, | |
2881 highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2882 | |
2883 /* If this item just became a submenu, we must set it. */ | |
2884 if (nsub != sub) | |
2885 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, nsub); | |
2886 } | |
2887 } | |
2888 else | |
2889 { | |
2890 /* Structural difference. Remove everything from here and down | |
2891 in SUBMENU. */ | |
2892 break; | |
2893 } | |
2894 } | |
2895 | |
2896 /* Remove widgets from first structual change. */ | |
2897 if (iter) | |
2898 { | |
2899 /* If we are adding new menu items below, we must remove from | |
2900 first radio button so that radio groups become correct. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2901 if (cur && first_radio) xg_destroy_widgets (first_radio); |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2902 else xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2903 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2904 |
49323 | 2905 if (cur) |
2906 { | |
2907 /* More items added. Create them. */ | |
2908 newsub = create_menus (cur, | |
2909 f, | |
2910 select_cb, | |
2911 deactivate_cb, | |
2912 highlight_cb, | |
2913 0, | |
2914 0, | |
2915 ! has_tearoff_p, | |
2916 submenu, | |
2917 cl_data, | |
2918 0); | |
2919 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2920 |
49572 | 2921 if (list) g_list_free (list); |
2922 | |
49323 | 2923 return newsub; |
2924 } | |
2925 | |
2926 /* Update the MENUBAR. | |
2927 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
2928 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
2929 If DEEP_P is non-zero, rebuild all but the top level menu names in | |
2930 the MENUBAR. If DEEP_P is zero, just rebuild the names in the menubar. | |
2931 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2932 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2933 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2934 |
49323 | 2935 void |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2936 xg_modify_menubar_widgets (GtkWidget *menubar, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2937 int deep_p, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2938 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2939 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 2940 { |
2941 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data; | |
2942 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2943 | |
2944 if (! list) return; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2945 |
49323 | 2946 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (menubar), |
2947 XG_FRAME_DATA); | |
2948 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2949 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, &list, list, 0, val->contents, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2950 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2951 |
64783
0975467abc17
* gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): Remove semicolon that
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
2952 if (deep_p) |
49323 | 2953 { |
2954 widget_value *cur; | |
2955 | |
2956 /* Update all sub menus. | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2957 We must keep the submenus (GTK menu item widgets) since the |
49323 | 2958 X Window in the XEvent that activates the menu are those widgets. */ |
2959 | |
2960 /* Update cl_data, menu_item things in F may have changed. */ | |
2961 update_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
2962 | |
2963 for (cur = val->contents; cur; cur = cur->next) | |
2964 { | |
49572 | 2965 GList *iter; |
49323 | 2966 GtkWidget *sub = 0; |
2967 GtkWidget *newsub; | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2968 GtkMenuItem *witem = 0; |
49323 | 2969 |
2970 /* Find sub menu that corresponds to val and update it. */ | |
2971 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) | |
2972 { | |
2973 witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); | |
2974 if (xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name)) | |
2975 { | |
2976 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
2977 break; | |
2978 } | |
2979 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2980 |
49323 | 2981 newsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, |
2982 f, | |
2983 cur->contents, | |
2984 select_cb, | |
2985 deactivate_cb, | |
2986 highlight_cb, | |
2987 cl_data); | |
2988 /* sub may still be NULL. If we just updated non deep and added | |
2989 a new menu bar item, it has no sub menu yet. So we set the | |
2990 newly created sub menu under witem. */ | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2991 if (newsub != sub && witem != 0) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2992 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2993 xg_set_screen (newsub, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2994 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, newsub); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2995 } |
49323 | 2996 } |
2997 } | |
2998 | |
49572 | 2999 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 3000 gtk_widget_show_all (menubar); |
3001 } | |
3002 | |
3003 /* Recompute all the widgets of frame F, when the menu bar has been | |
3004 changed. Value is non-zero if widgets were updated. */ | |
3005 | |
3006 int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3007 xg_update_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3008 { |
3009 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3010 GtkRequisition req; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3011 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3012 if (!x->menubar_widget || gtk_widget_get_mapped (x->menubar_widget)) |
49323 | 3013 return 0; |
3014 | |
106012
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3015 if (x->menubar_widget && gtk_widget_get_parent (x->menubar_widget)) |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3016 return 0; /* Already done this, happens for frames created invisible. */ |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3017 |
49323 | 3018 BLOCK_INPUT; |
3019 | |
3020 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, | |
3021 FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
3022 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, 0); | |
3023 | |
3024 gtk_widget_show_all (x->menubar_widget); | |
3025 gtk_widget_size_request (x->menubar_widget, &req); | |
3026 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3027 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3028 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
50106
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3029 |
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3030 return 1; |
49323 | 3031 } |
3032 | |
3033 /* Get rid of the menu bar of frame F, and free its storage. | |
3034 This is used when deleting a frame, and when turning off the menu bar. */ | |
3035 | |
3036 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3037 free_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3038 { |
3039 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3040 | |
3041 if (x->menubar_widget) | |
3042 { | |
3043 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
3044 | |
3045 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget); | |
3046 /* The menubar and its children shall be deleted when removed from | |
3047 the container. */ | |
3048 x->menubar_widget = 0; | |
3049 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3050 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3051 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
3052 } | |
3053 } | |
3054 | |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3055 int |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3056 xg_event_is_for_menubar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3057 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3058 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3059 GList *iter; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3060 GdkRectangle rec; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3061 GList *list; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3062 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3063 GdkWindow *gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3064 GdkEvent gevent; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3065 GtkWidget *gwdesc; |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3066 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3067 if (! x->menubar_widget) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3068 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3069 if (! (event->xbutton.x >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3070 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3071 && event->xbutton.y >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3072 && event->xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3073 && event->xbutton.same_screen)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3074 return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3075 |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3076 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3077 gw = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdpy, event->xbutton.window); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3078 if (! gw) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3079 gevent.any.window = gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3080 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&gevent); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3081 if (! gwdesc) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3082 if (! GTK_IS_MENU_BAR (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3083 && ! GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3084 && ! gtk_widget_is_ancestor (x->menubar_widget, gwdesc)) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3085 return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3086 |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3087 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (x->menubar_widget)); |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3088 if (! list) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3089 rec.x = event->xbutton.x; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3090 rec.y = event->xbutton.y; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3091 rec.width = 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3092 rec.height = 1; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3093 |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3094 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3095 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3096 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); |
109454
514fed5c0ded
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_resized): GTK_IS_MAPPED => gtk_widget_get_mapped, for Gtk 3.0
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109452
diff
changeset
|
3097 if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (w) && gtk_widget_intersect (w, &rec, NULL)) |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3098 break; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3099 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3100 g_list_free (list); |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3101 return iter == 0 ? 0 : 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3102 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3103 |
49323 | 3104 |
3105 | |
3106 /*********************************************************************** | |
3107 Scroll bar functions | |
3108 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3109 | |
3110 | |
3111 /* Setting scroll bar values invokes the callback. Use this variable | |
3112 to indicate that callback should do nothing. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3113 |
49323 | 3114 int xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar; |
3115 | |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3116 /* Xlib's `Window' fits in 32 bits. But we want to store pointers, and they |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3117 may be larger than 32 bits. Keep a mapping from integer index to widget |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3118 pointers to get around the 32 bit limitation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3119 |
49323 | 3120 static struct |
3121 { | |
3122 GtkWidget **widgets; | |
3123 int max_size; | |
3124 int used; | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
3125 } id_to_widget; |
49323 | 3126 |
3127 /* Grow this much every time we need to allocate more */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3128 |
49323 | 3129 #define ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR 32 |
3130 | |
3131 /* Store the widget pointer W in id_to_widget and return the integer index. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3132 |
49323 | 3133 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3134 xg_store_widget_in_map (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 3135 { |
3136 int i; | |
3137 | |
3138 if (id_to_widget.max_size == id_to_widget.used) | |
3139 { | |
3140 int new_size = id_to_widget.max_size + ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR; | |
3141 | |
3142 id_to_widget.widgets = xrealloc (id_to_widget.widgets, | |
3143 sizeof (GtkWidget *)*new_size); | |
3144 | |
3145 for (i = id_to_widget.max_size; i < new_size; ++i) | |
3146 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = 0; | |
3147 id_to_widget.max_size = new_size; | |
3148 } | |
3149 | |
3150 /* Just loop over the array and find a free place. After all, | |
3151 how many scroll bars are we creating? Should be a small number. | |
3152 The check above guarantees we will find a free place. */ | |
3153 for (i = 0; i < id_to_widget.max_size; ++i) | |
3154 { | |
3155 if (! id_to_widget.widgets[i]) | |
3156 { | |
3157 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = w; | |
3158 ++id_to_widget.used; | |
3159 | |
3160 return i; | |
3161 } | |
3162 } | |
3163 | |
3164 /* Should never end up here */ | |
3165 abort (); | |
3166 } | |
3167 | |
3168 /* Remove pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. | |
3169 Called when scroll bar is destroyed. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3170 |
49323 | 3171 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3172 xg_remove_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3173 { |
3174 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3175 { | |
3176 id_to_widget.widgets[idx] = 0; | |
3177 --id_to_widget.used; | |
3178 } | |
3179 } | |
3180 | |
3181 /* Get the widget pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3182 |
49323 | 3183 static GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3184 xg_get_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3185 { |
3186 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3187 return id_to_widget.widgets[idx]; | |
3188 | |
3189 return 0; | |
3190 } | |
3191 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3192 /* Return the scrollbar id for X Window WID on display DPY. |
50063 | 3193 Return -1 if WID not in id_to_widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3194 |
50063 | 3195 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3196 xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (Display *dpy, Window wid) |
50063 | 3197 { |
3198 int idx; | |
3199 GtkWidget *w; | |
3200 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3201 w = xg_win_to_widget (dpy, wid); |
50063 | 3202 |
3203 if (w) | |
3204 { | |
3205 for (idx = 0; idx < id_to_widget.max_size; ++idx) | |
3206 if (id_to_widget.widgets[idx] == w) | |
3207 return idx; | |
3208 } | |
3209 | |
3210 return -1; | |
3211 } | |
3212 | |
49323 | 3213 /* Callback invoked when scroll bar WIDGET is destroyed. |
3214 DATA is the index into id_to_widget for WIDGET. | |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
3215 We free pointer to last scroll bar values here and remove the index. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3216 |
49323 | 3217 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3218 xg_gtk_scroll_destroy (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
49323 | 3219 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3220 int id = (int) (EMACS_INT) data; /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3221 xg_remove_widget_from_map (id); |
3222 } | |
3223 | |
3224 /* Create a scroll bar widget for frame F. Store the scroll bar | |
3225 in BAR. | |
3226 SCROLL_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when the value of the | |
3227 bar changes. | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3228 END_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when scrolling ends. |
49323 | 3229 SCROLL_BAR_NAME is the name we use for the scroll bar. Can be used |
3230 to set resources for the widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3231 |
49323 | 3232 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3233 xg_create_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3234 struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3235 GCallback scroll_callback, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3236 GCallback end_callback, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3237 char *scroll_bar_name) |
49323 | 3238 { |
3239 GtkWidget *wscroll; | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3240 GtkWidget *webox; |
49323 | 3241 GtkObject *vadj; |
3242 int scroll_id; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3243 |
49323 | 3244 /* Page, step increment values are not so important here, they |
3245 will be corrected in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb. */ | |
3246 vadj = gtk_adjustment_new (XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MAX, | |
3247 0.1, 0.1, 0.1); | |
3248 | |
3249 wscroll = gtk_vscrollbar_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (vadj)); | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3250 webox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
49323 | 3251 gtk_widget_set_name (wscroll, scroll_bar_name); |
3252 gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS); | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3253 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wscroll), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3254 |
49323 | 3255 scroll_id = xg_store_widget_in_map (wscroll); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3256 |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3257 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3258 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3259 "destroy", | |
3260 G_CALLBACK (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy), | |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3261 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) scroll_id); |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3262 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3263 "change-value", |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3264 scroll_callback, |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3265 (gpointer) bar); |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3266 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3267 "button-release-event", |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3268 end_callback, |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3269 (gpointer) bar); |
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3270 |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3271 /* The scroll bar widget does not draw on a window of its own. Instead |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3272 it draws on the parent window, in this case the edit widget. So |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3273 whenever the edit widget is cleared, the scroll bar needs to redraw |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3274 also, which causes flicker. Put an event box between the edit widget |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3275 and the scroll bar, so the scroll bar instead draws itself on the |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3276 event box window. */ |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3277 gtk_fixed_put (GTK_FIXED (f->output_data.x->edit_widget), webox, -1, -1); |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3278 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (webox), wscroll); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3279 |
49323 | 3280 |
3281 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. */ | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3282 xg_set_cursor (webox, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 3283 |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3284 bar->x_window = scroll_id; |
49323 | 3285 } |
3286 | |
3287 /* Remove the scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID from the frame F. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3288 |
49323 | 3289 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3290 xg_remove_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, int scrollbar_id) |
49323 | 3291 { |
3292 GtkWidget *w = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
3293 if (w) | |
3294 { | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3295 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (w); |
49323 | 3296 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3297 gtk_widget_destroy (wparent); |
49323 | 3298 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3299 } | |
3300 } | |
3301 | |
3302 /* Update the position of the vertical scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID | |
3303 in frame F. | |
3304 TOP/LEFT are the new pixel positions where the bar shall appear. | |
3305 WIDTH, HEIGHT is the size in pixels the bar shall have. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3306 |
49323 | 3307 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3308 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3309 int scrollbar_id, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3310 int top, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3311 int left, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3312 int width, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3313 int height) |
49323 | 3314 { |
49572 | 3315 |
3316 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3317 |
49572 | 3318 if (wscroll) |
3319 { | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3320 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3321 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (wscroll); |
109040
98796fa1a7f8
src/gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Avoid C99 mid-block variable declaration.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
109037
diff
changeset
|
3322 gint msl; |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3323 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3324 /* Clear out old position. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3325 int oldx = -1, oldy = -1, oldw, oldh; |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3326 if (gtk_widget_get_parent (wparent) == wfixed) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3327 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3328 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (wfixed), wparent, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3329 "x", &oldx, "y", &oldy, NULL); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3330 gtk_widget_get_size_request (wscroll, &oldw, &oldh); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3331 } |
55342
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3332 |
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3333 /* Move and resize to new values. */ |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3334 gtk_fixed_move (GTK_FIXED (wfixed), wparent, left, top); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3335 gtk_widget_style_get (wscroll, "min-slider-length", &msl, NULL); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3336 if (msl > height) |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3337 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3338 /* No room. Hide scroll bar as some themes output a warning if |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3339 the height is less than the min size. */ |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3340 gtk_widget_hide (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3341 gtk_widget_hide (wscroll); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3342 } |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3343 else |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3344 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3345 gtk_widget_show_all (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3346 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wscroll, width, height); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3347 } |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3348 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3349 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3350 if (oldx != -1 && oldw > 0 && oldh > 0) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3351 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3352 /* Clear under old scroll bar position. This must be done after |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3353 the gtk_widget_queue_draw and gdk_window_process_all_updates |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3354 above. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3355 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3356 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3357 oldx, oldy, oldw, oldh, 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3358 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3359 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3360 /* GTK does not redraw until the main loop is entered again, but |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3361 if there are no X events pending we will not enter it. So we sync |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3362 here to get some events. */ |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3363 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3364 x_sync (f); |
49572 | 3365 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3366 cancel_mouse_face (f); | |
3367 } | |
49323 | 3368 } |
3369 | |
3370 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently | |
3371 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3372 |
49323 | 3373 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3374 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3375 int portion, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3376 int position, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3377 int whole) |
49323 | 3378 { |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3379 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (bar->x_window); |
49323 | 3380 |
3381 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window))); | |
3382 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3383 if (wscroll && NILP (bar->dragging)) |
49323 | 3384 { |
3385 GtkAdjustment *adj; | |
3386 gdouble shown; | |
3387 gdouble top; | |
3388 int size, value; | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3389 int new_step; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3390 int changed = 0; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3391 |
49323 | 3392 adj = gtk_range_get_adjustment (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)); |
3393 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3394 /* We do the same as for MOTIF in xterm.c, assume 30 chars per line |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3395 rather than the real portion value. This makes the thumb less likely |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3396 to resize and that looks better. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3397 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30; |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3398 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole. |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3399 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */ |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3400 whole += portion; |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3401 |
49323 | 3402 if (whole <= 0) |
3403 top = 0, shown = 1; | |
3404 else | |
3405 { | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3406 top = (gdouble) position / whole; |
49323 | 3407 shown = (gdouble) portion / whole; |
3408 } | |
3409 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3410 size = shown * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3411 size = min (size, XG_SB_RANGE); |
49323 | 3412 size = max (size, 1); |
3413 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3414 value = top * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3415 value = min (value, XG_SB_MAX - size); |
49323 | 3416 value = max (value, XG_SB_MIN); |
3417 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3418 /* Assume all lines are of equal size. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3419 new_step = size / max (1, FRAME_LINES (f)); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3420 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3421 if ((int) gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj) != size |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3422 || (int) gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment (adj) != new_step) |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3423 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3424 gtk_adjustment_set_page_size (adj, size); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3425 gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment (adj, new_step); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3426 /* Assume a page increment is about 95% of the page size */ |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3427 gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment (adj,(int) (0.95*size)); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3428 changed = 1; |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3429 } |
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3430 |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3431 if (changed || (int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3432 { |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3433 BLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3434 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3435 /* gtk_range_set_value invokes the callback. Set |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3436 ignore_gtk_scrollbar to make the callback do nothing */ |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3437 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 1; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3438 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3439 if ((int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3440 gtk_range_set_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), (gdouble)value); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3441 else if (changed) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3442 gtk_adjustment_changed (adj); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3443 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3444 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3445 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3446 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3447 } |
49323 | 3448 } |
3449 } | |
3450 | |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3451 /* Return non-zero if EVENT is for a scroll bar in frame F. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3452 When the same X window is used for several Gtk+ widgets, we cannot |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3453 say for sure based on the X window alone if an event is for the |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3454 frame. This function does additional checks. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3455 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3456 Return non-zero if the event is for a scroll bar, zero otherwise. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3457 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3458 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3459 xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3460 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3461 int retval = 0; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3462 |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3463 if (f && event->type == ButtonPress && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3464 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3465 /* Check if press occurred outside the edit widget. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3466 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3467 retval = gdk_display_get_window_at_pointer (gdpy, NULL, NULL) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3468 != gtk_widget_get_window (f->output_data.x->edit_widget); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3469 } |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3470 else if (f |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3471 && ((event->type == ButtonRelease && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3472 || event->type == MotionNotify)) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3473 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3474 /* If we are releasing or moving the scroll bar, it has the grab. */ |
107997
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3475 GtkWidget *w = gtk_grab_get_current (); |
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3476 retval = w != 0 && GTK_IS_SCROLLBAR (w); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3477 } |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3478 |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3479 return retval; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3480 } |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3481 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3482 |
49323 | 3483 |
3484 /*********************************************************************** | |
3485 Tool bar functions | |
3486 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3487 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is | |
3488 the image used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update | |
3489 the GtkImage with a new image. */ | |
3490 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA "emacs-tool-bar-image" | |
3491 | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3492 /* The key for storing the latest modifiers so the activate callback can |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3493 get them. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3494 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER "emacs-tool-bar-modifier" |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3495 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3496 /* The key for storing the button widget in its proxy menu item. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3497 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON "emacs-tool-bar-proxy-button" |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3498 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3499 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3500 the stock name used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3501 the GtkImage with a new image. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3502 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-stock-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3503 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3504 /* As above, but this is used for named theme widgets, as opposed to |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3505 stock items. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3506 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-icon-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3507 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3508 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3509 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3510 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3511 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3512 |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3513 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3514 xg_tool_bar_button_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3515 GdkEventButton *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3516 gpointer user_data) |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3517 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3518 /* Casts to avoid warnings when gpointer is 64 bits and int is 32 bits */ |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3519 gpointer ptr = (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) event->state; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3520 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER, ptr); |
68922 | 3521 return FALSE; |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3522 } |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3523 |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3524 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3525 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3526 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3527 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3528 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3529 |
49323 | 3530 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3531 xg_tool_bar_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3532 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3533 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3534 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3535 int mod = (int) (EMACS_INT) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3536 XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER); |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3537 |
49323 | 3538 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3539 Lisp_Object key, frame; | |
3540 struct input_event event; | |
51569
e7bd8581e306
(xg_tool_bar_callback): Don't pass uninitialized
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
51432
diff
changeset
|
3541 EVENT_INIT (event); |
49323 | 3542 |
3543 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
3544 return; | |
3545 | |
3546 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3547 |
49323 | 3548 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY); |
3549 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
78538
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3550 |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3551 /* We generate two events here. The first one is to set the prefix |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3552 to `(tool_bar)', see keyboard.c. */ |
49323 | 3553 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
3554 event.frame_or_window = frame; | |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3555 event.arg = frame; |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3556 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3557 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3558 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
49323 | 3559 event.frame_or_window = frame; |
3560 event.arg = key; | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3561 /* Convert between the modifier bits GDK uses and the modifier bits |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3562 Emacs uses. This assumes GDK and X masks are the same, which they are when |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3563 this is written. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3564 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), mod); |
49323 | 3565 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3566 |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3567 /* Return focus to the frame after we have clicked on a detached |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3568 tool bar button. */ |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3569 Fx_focus_frame (frame); |
49323 | 3570 } |
3571 | |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3572 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed in a detached |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3573 tool bar or the overflow drop down menu. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3574 We just call xg_tool_bar_callback. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3575 W is the menu item widget that got pressed, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3576 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3577 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3578 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3579 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3580 xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3581 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3582 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3583 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3584 xg_tool_bar_callback (wbutton, client_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3585 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3586 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3587 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3588 static gboolean |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3589 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3590 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3591 gpointer client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3592 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3593 /* This callback is called when a help is to be shown for an item in |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3594 the detached tool bar when the detached tool bar it is not expanded. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3595 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3596 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3597 xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3598 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3599 gpointer client_data) |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3600 { |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3601 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3602 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3603 |
106512
471e6932ea09
(xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): Fix missing return.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
106186
diff
changeset
|
3604 return xg_tool_bar_help_callback (wbutton, event, client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3605 } |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3606 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3607 static GtkWidget * |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3608 xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (GtkWidget *vb, GtkWidget **wimage) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3609 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3610 GList *clist = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (vb)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3611 GtkWidget *c1 = (GtkWidget *) clist->data; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3612 GtkWidget *c2 = (GtkWidget *) clist->next->data; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3613 *wimage = GTK_IS_IMAGE (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3614 g_list_free (clist); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3615 return GTK_IS_LABEL (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3616 } |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3617 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3618 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3619 /* This callback is called when a tool item should create a proxy item, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3620 such as for the overflow menu. Also called when the tool bar is detached. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3621 If we don't create a proxy menu item, the detached tool bar will be |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3622 blank. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3623 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3624 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3625 xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy (GtkToolItem *toolitem, gpointer user_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3626 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3627 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (toolitem)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3628 GtkButton *wbutton = GTK_BUTTON (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox))); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3629 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3630 GtkWidget *c1; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3631 GtkLabel *wlbl = GTK_LABEL (xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &c1)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3632 GtkImage *wimage = GTK_IMAGE (c1); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3633 GtkWidget *wmenuitem = gtk_image_menu_item_new_with_label |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3634 (gtk_label_get_text (wlbl)); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3635 GtkWidget *wmenuimage; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3636 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3637 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3638 if (gtk_button_get_use_stock (wbutton)) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3639 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (gtk_button_get_label (wbutton), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3640 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3641 else |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3642 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3643 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3644 GtkImageType store_type = gtk_image_get_storage_type (wimage); |
85938
d7e05ac913d8
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
84621
diff
changeset
|
3645 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3646 if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_STOCK) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3647 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3648 gchar *stock_id; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3649 gtk_image_get_stock (wimage, &stock_id, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3650 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_id, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3651 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3652 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_SET) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3653 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3654 GtkIconSet *icon_set; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3655 gtk_image_get_icon_set (wimage, &icon_set, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3656 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_set (icon_set, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3657 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3658 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3659 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3660 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3661 gint width, height; |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3662 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3663 if (settings && |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3664 gtk_icon_size_lookup_for_settings (settings, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3665 &width, &height)) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3666 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3667 GdkPixbuf *src_pixbuf, *dest_pixbuf; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3668 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3669 src_pixbuf = gtk_image_get_pixbuf (wimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3670 dest_pixbuf = gdk_pixbuf_scale_simple (src_pixbuf, width, height, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3671 GDK_INTERP_BILINEAR); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3672 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3673 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (dest_pixbuf); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3674 } |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3675 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3676 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3677 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF failed\n"); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3678 abort (); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3679 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3680 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3681 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME) |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3682 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3683 const gchar *icon_name; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3684 GtkIconSize icon_size; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3685 |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3686 gtk_image_get_icon_name (wimage, &icon_name, &icon_size); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3687 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3688 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3689 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3690 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3691 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3692 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: store_type is %d\n", store_type); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3693 abort (); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3694 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3695 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3696 if (wmenuimage) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3697 gtk_image_menu_item_set_image (GTK_IMAGE_MENU_ITEM (wmenuitem), wmenuimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3698 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3699 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3700 "activate", |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
3701 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback), |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3702 user_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3703 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3704 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3705 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3706 (gpointer) wbutton); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3707 gtk_tool_item_set_proxy_menu_item (toolitem, "Emacs toolbar item", wmenuitem); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3708 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wmenuitem, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3709 gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton))); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3710 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3711 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3712 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3713 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3714 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3715 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3716 "enter-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3717 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3718 user_data); |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3719 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3720 "leave-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3721 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3722 user_data); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3723 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3724 return TRUE; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3725 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3726 |
49323 | 3727 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is detached. We must set |
3728 the height of the tool bar to zero when this happens so frame sizes | |
3729 are correctly calculated. | |
3730 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3731 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3732 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3733 |
49323 | 3734 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3735 xg_tool_bar_detach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3736 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3737 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3738 { |
3739 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3740 extern int x_gtk_whole_detached_tool_bar; |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3741 |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3742 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", !x_gtk_whole_detached_tool_bar, |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3743 NULL); |
49323 | 3744 |
3745 if (f) | |
3746 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3747 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3748 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 1; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3749 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3750 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3751 req.width -= req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3752 req.height -= req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3753 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3754 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3755 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3756 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3757 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3758 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3759 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3760 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3761 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3762 } |
3763 } | |
3764 | |
3765 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is reattached. We must set | |
3766 the height of the tool bar when this happens so frame sizes | |
3767 are correctly calculated. | |
3768 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3769 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3770 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3771 |
49323 | 3772 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3773 xg_tool_bar_attach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3774 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3775 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3776 { |
3777 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3778 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", TRUE, NULL); |
49323 | 3779 |
3780 if (f) | |
3781 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3782 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3783 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 0; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3784 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3785 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3786 req.width += req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3787 req.height += req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3788 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3789 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3790 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3791 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3792 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3793 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3794 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3795 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3796 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3797 } |
3798 } | |
3799 | |
3800 /* This callback is called when the mouse enters or leaves a tool bar item. | |
3801 It is used for displaying and hiding the help text. | |
3802 W is the tool bar item, a button. | |
3803 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. | |
3804 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the | |
3805 tool bar. 0 is the first button. | |
3806 | |
3807 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3808 |
49323 | 3809 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3810 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3811 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3812 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3813 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3814 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3815 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
49323 | 3816 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3817 Lisp_Object help, frame; | |
3818 | |
3819 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
50108
a9ff586d3d09
(xg_tool_bar_help_callback): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50106
diff
changeset
|
3820 return FALSE; |
49323 | 3821 |
3822 if (event->type == GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY) | |
3823 { | |
3824 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
3825 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP); | |
3826 | |
3827 if (NILP (help)) | |
3828 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION); | |
3829 } | |
3830 else | |
3831 help = Qnil; | |
3832 | |
3833 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
3834 kbd_buffer_store_help_event (frame, help); | |
3835 | |
3836 return FALSE; | |
3837 } | |
3838 | |
3839 | |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3840 /* This callback is called when a tool bar item shall be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3841 It modifies the expose event so that the GtkImage widget redraws the |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3842 whole image. This to overcome a bug that makes GtkImage draw the image |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3843 in the wrong place when it tries to redraw just a part of the image. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3844 W is the GtkImage to be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3845 EVENT is the expose event for W. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3846 CLIENT_DATA is unused. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3847 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3848 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3849 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3850 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3851 xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3852 GdkEventExpose *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3853 gpointer client_data) |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3854 { |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3855 gint width, height; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3856 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3857 gdk_drawable_get_size (event->window, &width, &height); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3858 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3859 event->area.x -= width > event->area.width ? width-event->area.width : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3860 event->area.y -= height > event->area.height ? height-event->area.height : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3861 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3862 event->area.x = max (0, event->area.x); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3863 event->area.y = max (0, event->area.y); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3864 |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3865 event->area.width = max (width, event->area.width); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3866 event->area.height = max (height, event->area.height); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3867 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3868 return FALSE; |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3869 } |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3870 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3871 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_ORIENTABLE_SET_ORIENTATION |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3872 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3873 gtk_orientable_set_orientation (GTK_ORIENTABLE (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3874 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3875 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3876 gtk_toolbar_set_orientation (GTK_TOOLBAR (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3877 #endif |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3878 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3879 /* Attach a tool bar to frame F. */ |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3880 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3881 static void |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3882 xg_pack_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3883 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3884 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3885 int into_hbox = EQ (pos, Qleft) || EQ (pos, Qright); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3886 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3887 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3888 into_hbox |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3889 ? GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3890 : GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3891 if (!x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3892 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3893 x->handlebox_widget = gtk_handle_box_new (); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3894 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-detached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3895 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3896 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-attached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3897 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_attach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3898 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (x->handlebox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3899 x->toolbar_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3900 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3901 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3902 if (into_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3903 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3904 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3905 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3906 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3907 if (EQ (pos, Qleft)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3908 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3909 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3910 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3911 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3912 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3913 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3914 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3915 int vbox_pos = x->menubar_widget ? 1 : 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3916 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3917 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3918 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3919 if (EQ (pos, Qtop)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3920 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3921 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3922 vbox_pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3923 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3924 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3925 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3926 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3927 /* Create a tool bar for frame F. */ |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3928 |
49323 | 3929 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3930 xg_create_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3931 { |
3932 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3933 | |
3934 x->toolbar_widget = gtk_toolbar_new (); | |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3935 x->toolbar_detached = 0; |
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3936 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3937 gtk_widget_set_name (x->toolbar_widget, "emacs-toolbar"); |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3938 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3939 gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget), GTK_TOOLBAR_ICONS); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3940 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
49323 | 3941 } |
3942 | |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3943 |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3944 #define PROP(IDX) AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX)) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3945 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3946 /* Find the right-to-left image named by RTL in the tool bar images for F. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3947 Returns IMAGE if RTL is not found. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3948 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3949 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3950 find_rtl_image (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object image, Lisp_Object rtl) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3951 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3952 int i; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3953 Lisp_Object file, rtl_name; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3954 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3955 GCPRO2 (file, rtl_name); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3956 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3957 rtl_name = Ffile_name_nondirectory (rtl); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3958 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3959 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3960 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3961 Lisp_Object rtl_image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3962 if (!NILP (file = file_for_image (rtl_image))) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3963 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3964 file = call1 (intern ("file-name-sans-extension"), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3965 Ffile_name_nondirectory (file)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3966 if (EQ (Fequal (file, rtl_name), Qt)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3967 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3968 image = rtl_image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3969 break; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3970 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3971 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3972 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3973 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3974 return image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3975 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3976 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3977 static GtkToolItem * |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3978 xg_make_tool_item (FRAME_PTR f, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3979 GtkWidget *wimage, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3980 GtkWidget **wbutton, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3981 char *label, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3982 int i) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3983 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3984 GtkToolItem *ti = gtk_tool_item_new (); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3985 Lisp_Object style = Ftool_bar_get_system_style (); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3986 int both_horiz = EQ (style, Qboth_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3987 int text_image = EQ (style, Qtext_image_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3988 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3989 GtkWidget *vb = both_horiz || text_image |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3990 ? gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0) : gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3991 GtkWidget *wb = gtk_button_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3992 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3993 |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3994 if (wimage && ! text_image) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3995 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3996 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3997 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), gtk_label_new (label), TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3998 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
3999 if (wimage && text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4000 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4001 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4002 gtk_button_set_focus_on_click (GTK_BUTTON (wb), FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4003 gtk_button_set_relief (GTK_BUTTON (wb), GTK_RELIEF_NONE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4004 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wb), vb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4005 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (weventbox), wb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4006 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (ti), weventbox); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4007 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4008 if (wimage) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4009 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4010 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4011 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), "create-menu-proxy", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4012 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4013 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4014 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4015 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wb), "clicked", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4016 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4017 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4018 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4019 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (weventbox), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4020 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4021 /* Catch expose events to overcome an annoying redraw bug, see |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4022 comment for xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4023 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4024 "expose-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4025 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4026 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4027 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4028 gtk_tool_item_set_homogeneous (ti, FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4029 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4030 /* Callback to save modifyer mask (Shift/Control, etc). GTK makes |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4031 no distinction based on modifiers in the activate callback, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4032 so we have to do it ourselves. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4033 g_signal_connect (wb, "button-release-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4034 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_button_cb), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4035 NULL); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4036 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4037 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wb), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4038 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4039 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4040 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4041 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4042 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4043 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4044 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4045 "enter-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4046 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4047 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4048 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4049 "leave-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4050 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4051 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4052 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4053 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4054 if (wbutton) *wbutton = wb; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4055 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4056 return ti; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4057 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4058 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4059 static void |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4060 xg_show_toolbar_item (GtkToolItem *ti) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4061 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4062 Lisp_Object style = Ftool_bar_get_system_style (); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4063 int both_horiz = EQ (style, Qboth_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4064 int text_image = EQ (style, Qtext_image_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4065 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4066 int horiz = both_horiz || text_image; |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4067 int show_label = ! EQ (style, Qimage); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4068 int show_image = ! EQ (style, Qtext); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4069 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4070 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4071 GtkWidget *wbutton = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox)); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4072 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4073 GtkWidget *wimage; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4074 GtkWidget *wlbl = xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &wimage); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4075 GtkWidget *new_box = NULL; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4076 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4077 if (GTK_IS_VBOX (vb) && horiz) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4078 new_box = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4079 else if (GTK_IS_HBOX (vb) && !horiz && show_label && show_image) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4080 new_box = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4081 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4082 if (!new_box && horiz) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4083 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (vb), wlbl, text_image ? 0 : 1); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4084 else if (new_box) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4085 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4086 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wimage)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4087 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4088 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (vb), wimage); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4089 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (vb), wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4090 gtk_widget_destroy (GTK_WIDGET (vb)); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4091 if (! text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4092 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4093 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wlbl, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4094 if (text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4095 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4096 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wbutton), new_box); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4097 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wimage)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4098 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4099 vb = new_box; |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4100 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4101 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4102 if (show_label) gtk_widget_show (wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4103 else gtk_widget_hide (wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4104 if (show_image) gtk_widget_show (wimage); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4105 else gtk_widget_hide (wimage); |
108315
8bb62bdbd80a
Fix bug #6139, text is briefly shown in tool bar on startup.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108082
diff
changeset
|
4106 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (weventbox)); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4107 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (vb)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4108 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4109 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4110 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4111 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4112 static int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4113 xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (FRAME_PTR f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4114 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4115 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4116 GtkRequisition req; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4117 int nl = 0, nr = 0, nt = 0, nb = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4118 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4119 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->handlebox_widget), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4120 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4121 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4122 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4123 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4124 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4125 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4126 if (pos == 0) nl = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4127 else nr = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4128 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4129 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4130 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4131 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4132 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4133 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4134 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4135 if (pos == 0 || (pos == 1 && x->menubar_widget)) nt = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4136 else nb = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4137 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4138 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4139 if (nl != FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4140 || nr != FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4141 || nt != FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4142 || nb != FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4143 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4144 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4145 = FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4146 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = nl; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4147 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = nr; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4148 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = nt; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4149 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = nb; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4150 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4151 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4152 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4153 return 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4154 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4155 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4156 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4157 /* Update the tool bar for frame F. Add new buttons and remove old. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4158 |
49323 | 4159 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4160 update_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4161 { |
4162 int i; | |
4163 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
75576
e852dba095f9
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize h/vmargin to 0.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75417
diff
changeset
|
4164 int hmargin = 0, vmargin = 0; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4165 GtkToolbar *wtoolbar; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4166 GtkToolItem *ti; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4167 GtkTextDirection dir; |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4168 int pack_tool_bar = x->handlebox_widget == NULL; |
49323 | 4169 |
4170 if (! FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) | |
4171 return; | |
4172 | |
4173 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4174 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4175 if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4176 && XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4177 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4178 hmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4179 vmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4180 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4181 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4182 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4183 if (INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4184 && XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4185 hmargin = XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4186 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4187 if (INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4188 && XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4189 vmargin = XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4190 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4191 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4192 /* The natural size (i.e. when GTK uses 0 as margin) looks best, |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4193 so take DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN to mean "default for GTK", |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4194 i.e. zero. This means that margins less than |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4195 DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN has no effect. */ |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4196 hmargin = max (0, hmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4197 vmargin = max (0, vmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
4198 |
49323 | 4199 if (! x->toolbar_widget) |
4200 xg_create_tool_bar (f); | |
4201 | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4202 wtoolbar = GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4203 dir = gtk_widget_get_direction (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4204 |
49323 | 4205 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
4206 { | |
4207 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P)); | |
4208 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P)); | |
4209 int idx; | |
4210 int img_id; | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4211 int icon_size = 0; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4212 struct image *img = NULL; |
49323 | 4213 Lisp_Object image; |
100100
f5d2a2e44839
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize variable.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98555
diff
changeset
|
4214 Lisp_Object stock = Qnil; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4215 GtkStockItem stock_item; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4216 char *stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4217 char *icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4218 Lisp_Object rtl; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4219 GtkWidget *wbutton = NULL; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4220 GtkWidget *weventbox; |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4221 Lisp_Object specified_file; |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4222 char *label = SSDATA (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_LABEL)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4223 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4224 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), i); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4225 |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4226 if (ti) |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4227 { |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4228 weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (ti)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4229 wbutton = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4230 } |
49323 | 4231 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4232 |
49323 | 4233 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
4234 | |
4235 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */ | |
4236 if (!valid_image_p (image)) | |
4237 { | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4238 if (wbutton) gtk_widget_hide (wbutton); |
49323 | 4239 continue; |
4240 } | |
4241 | |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4242 specified_file = file_for_image (image); |
103916
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4243 if (!NILP (specified_file) && !NILP (Ffboundp (Qx_gtk_map_stock))) |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4244 stock = call1 (Qx_gtk_map_stock, specified_file); |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4245 |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4246 if (STRINGP (stock)) |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4247 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4248 stock_name = SSDATA (stock); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4249 if (stock_name[0] == 'n' && stock_name[1] == ':') |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4250 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4251 GdkScreen *screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4252 GtkIconTheme *icon_theme = gtk_icon_theme_get_for_screen (screen); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4253 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4254 icon_name = stock_name + 2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4255 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4256 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4257 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4258 if (! gtk_icon_theme_has_icon (icon_theme, icon_name)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4259 icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4260 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4261 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4262 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4263 else if (gtk_stock_lookup (SSDATA (stock), &stock_item)) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4264 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4265 else |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4266 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4267 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4268 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4269 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4270 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4271 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4272 if (stock_name == NULL && icon_name == NULL) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4273 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4274 /* No stock image, or stock item not known. Try regular image. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4275 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4276 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4277 button state. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4278 if (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4279 && !NILP (rtl = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_RTL_IMAGE)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4280 && STRINGP (rtl)) |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4281 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4282 image = find_rtl_image (f, image, rtl); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4283 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4284 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4285 if (VECTORP (image)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4286 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4287 if (enabled_p) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4288 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4289 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4290 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4291 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4292 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4293 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4294 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4295 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4296 xassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4297 image = AREF (image, idx); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4298 } |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4299 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4300 idx = -1; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4301 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4302 img_id = lookup_image (f, image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4303 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, img_id); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4304 prepare_image_for_display (f, img); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4305 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4306 if (img->load_failed_p || img->pixmap == None) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4307 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4308 if (ti) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4309 gtk_widget_hide_all (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4310 else |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4311 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4312 /* Insert an empty (non-image) button */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4313 ti = xg_make_tool_item (f, NULL, NULL, "", i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4314 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, -1); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4315 } |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4316 continue; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4317 } |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4318 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4319 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4320 if (ti == NULL) |
49323 | 4321 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4322 GtkWidget *w; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4323 if (stock_name) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4324 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4325 w = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4326 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4327 (gpointer) xstrdup (stock_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4328 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4329 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4330 else if (icon_name) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4331 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4332 w = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4333 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4334 (gpointer) xstrdup (icon_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4335 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4336 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4337 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4338 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4339 w = xg_get_image_for_pixmap (f, img, x->widget, NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4340 /* Save the image so we can see if an update is needed when |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4341 this function is called again. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4342 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4343 (gpointer)img->pixmap); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4344 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4345 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4346 gtk_misc_set_padding (GTK_MISC (w), hmargin, vmargin); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4347 ti = xg_make_tool_item (f, w, &wbutton, label, i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4348 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, -1); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4349 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wbutton, enabled_p); |
49323 | 4350 } |
4351 else | |
4352 { | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4353 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4354 GtkWidget *wimage; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4355 GtkWidget *wlbl = xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &wimage); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4356 |
50059
ffb4a4dbe4c0
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Compare pixmap ID instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49826
diff
changeset
|
4357 Pixmap old_img = (Pixmap)g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
ffb4a4dbe4c0
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Compare pixmap ID instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49826
diff
changeset
|
4358 XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4359 gpointer old_stock_name = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4360 XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4361 gpointer old_icon_name = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4362 XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4363 gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (wlbl), label); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4364 if (stock_name && |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4365 (! old_stock_name || strcmp (old_stock_name, stock_name) != 0)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4366 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4367 gtk_image_set_from_stock (GTK_IMAGE (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4368 stock_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4369 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4370 (gpointer) xstrdup (stock_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4371 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4372 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4373 NULL); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4374 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4375 NULL); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4376 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4377 else if (icon_name && |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4378 (! old_icon_name || strcmp (old_icon_name, icon_name) != 0)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4379 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4380 gtk_image_set_from_icon_name (GTK_IMAGE (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4381 icon_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4382 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4383 (gpointer) xstrdup (icon_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4384 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4385 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4386 NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4387 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4388 NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4389 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4390 else if (img && old_img != img->pixmap) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4391 { |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
4392 (void) xg_get_image_for_pixmap (f, img, x->widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
4393 GTK_IMAGE (wimage)); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4394 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4395 (gpointer)img->pixmap); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4396 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4397 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4398 NULL); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4399 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4400 NULL); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4401 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4402 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4403 gtk_misc_set_padding (GTK_MISC (wimage), hmargin, vmargin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4404 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4405 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wbutton, enabled_p); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4406 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4407 xg_show_toolbar_item (ti); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4408 |
49323 | 4409 #undef PROP |
4410 } | |
4411 | |
4412 /* Remove buttons not longer needed. We just hide them so they | |
4413 can be reused later on. */ | |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4414 do |
49323 | 4415 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4416 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), i++); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4417 if (ti) gtk_widget_hide_all (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4418 } while (ti != NULL); |
49323 | 4419 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4420 if (f->n_tool_bar_items != 0) |
49323 | 4421 { |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4422 if (pack_tool_bar) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4423 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, f->tool_bar_position); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4424 gtk_widget_show (x->toolbar_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4425 gtk_widget_show (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4426 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4427 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 4428 } |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4429 |
49323 | 4430 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4431 } | |
4432 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4433 /* Deallocate all resources for the tool bar on frame F. |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4434 Remove the tool bar. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4435 |
49323 | 4436 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4437 free_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4438 { |
4439 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
4440 | |
4441 if (x->toolbar_widget) | |
4442 { | |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4443 int is_packed = x->handlebox_widget != 0; |
49323 | 4444 BLOCK_INPUT; |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4445 /* We may have created the toolbar_widget in xg_create_tool_bar, but |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4446 not the x->handlebox_widget which is created in xg_pack_tool_bar. */ |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4447 if (is_packed) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4448 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4449 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4450 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4451 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4452 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4453 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4454 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4455 } |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4456 else |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4457 gtk_widget_destroy (x->toolbar_widget); |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4458 |
49323 | 4459 x->toolbar_widget = 0; |
4460 x->handlebox_widget = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4461 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4462 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4463 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4464 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
4465 |
49323 | 4466 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4467 } | |
4468 } | |
4469 | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4470 int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4471 xg_change_toolbar_position (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4472 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4473 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4474 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4475 if (! x->toolbar_widget || ! x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4476 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4477 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4478 BLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4479 g_object_ref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4480 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4481 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4482 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4483 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4484 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4485 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4486 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4487 g_object_unref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4488 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4489 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4490 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4491 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4492 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4493 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4494 |
49323 | 4495 |
4496 | |
4497 /*********************************************************************** | |
4498 Initializing | |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4499 ***********************************************************************/ |
49323 | 4500 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4501 xg_initialize (void) |
49323 | 4502 { |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4503 GtkBindingSet *binding_set; |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4504 |
75417
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4505 #if HAVE_XFT |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4506 /* Work around a bug with corrupted data if libXft gets unloaded. This way |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4507 we keep it permanently linked in. */ |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4508 XftInit (0); |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4509 #endif |
84621 | 4510 |
4511 gdpy_def = NULL; | |
49323 | 4512 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4513 xg_detached_menus = 0; |
49323 | 4514 xg_menu_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_cb_list.next = |
4515 xg_menu_item_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next = 0; | |
4516 | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4517 id_to_widget.max_size = id_to_widget.used = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4518 id_to_widget.widgets = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4519 |
49323 | 4520 /* Remove F10 as a menu accelerator, it does not mix well with Emacs key |
4521 bindings. It doesn't seem to be any way to remove properties, | |
4522 so we set it to VoidSymbol which in X means "no key". */ | |
4523 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), | |
4524 "gtk-menu-bar-accel", | |
4525 "VoidSymbol", | |
4526 EMACS_CLASS); | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4527 |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4528 /* Make GTK text input widgets use Emacs style keybindings. This is |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4529 Emacs after all. */ |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4530 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4531 "gtk-key-theme-name", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4532 "Emacs", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4533 EMACS_CLASS); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4534 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4535 /* Make dialogs close on C-g. Since file dialog inherits from |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4536 dialog, this works for them also. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4537 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref (GTK_TYPE_DIALOG)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4538 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4539 "close", 0); |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4540 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4541 /* Make menus close on C-g. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4542 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref |
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4543 (GTK_TYPE_MENU_SHELL)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4544 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4545 "cancel", 0); |
49323 | 4546 } |
4547 | |
4548 #endif /* USE_GTK */ | |
52401 | 4549 |
4550 /* arch-tag: fe7104da-bc1e-4aba-9bd1-f349c528f7e3 | |
4551 (do not change this comment) */ |